blob: 1c6c8468da8c392f889467dc3d10305c995c1c2d [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau33205c22020-07-07 16:35:28 +02005 version 2.3
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreaue732cbd2020-07-17 15:13:19 +02007 2020/07/17
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100553.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200563.9. Rings
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020057
584. Proxies
594.1. Proxy keywords matrix
604.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
61
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100625. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200635.1. Bind options
645.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200655.3. Server DNS resolution
665.3.1. Global overview
675.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020068
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100696. Cache
706.1. Limitation
716.2. Setup
726.2.1. Cache section
736.2.2. Proxy section
74
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200757. Using ACLs and fetching samples
767.1. ACL basics
777.1.1. Matching booleans
787.1.2. Matching integers
797.1.3. Matching strings
807.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
817.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
827.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
837.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
847.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200857.3.1. Converters
867.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
877.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
887.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
897.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
907.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200917.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200927.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020093
948. Logging
958.1. Log levels
968.2. Log formats
978.2.1. Default log format
988.2.2. TCP log format
998.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01001008.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +01001018.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001028.3. Advanced logging options
1038.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1048.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1058.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1068.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1078.4. Timing events
1088.5. Session state at disconnection
1098.6. Non-printable characters
1108.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1118.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1128.9. Examples of logs
113
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001149. Supported filters
1159.1. Trace
1169.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001179.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001189.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001199.5. fcgi-app
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200120
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012110. FastCGI applications
12210.1. Setup
12310.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12410.1.2. Proxy section
12510.1.3. Example
12610.2. Default parameters
12710.3. Limitations
128
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129
1301. Quick reminder about HTTP
131----------------------------
132
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100133When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200134fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
135on almost anything found in the contents.
136
137However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
138formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
139correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
140
141
1421.1. The HTTP transaction model
143-------------------------------
144
145The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100146to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100147from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
148connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200149will involve a new connection :
150
151 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
152
153In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
154establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
155by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
156length.
157
158Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
159to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
160however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
161response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
162header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
163
164 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
165
166Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
167power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
168but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200169a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100171Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
173second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
174page :
175
176 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
177
178This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
179latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
180correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
181the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100182server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200183
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100184The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
185time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
186are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
187parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
188carry the stream identifier.
189
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100190By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
191connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
192leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100193start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
194processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
195waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200196
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200197HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100198 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
199 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100200 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100201 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200202 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100203
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100204
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200205
2061.2. HTTP request
207-----------------
208
209First, let's consider this HTTP request :
210
211 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100212 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200213 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
214 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
215 3 User-agent: my small browser
216 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
217 5 Accept: image/png
218
219
2201.2.1. The Request line
221-----------------------
222
223Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
224
225 - a METHOD : GET
226 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
227 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
228
229All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
230which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
231followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
232is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
233desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
234the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
235
236The URI itself can have several forms :
237
238 - A "relative URI" :
239
240 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
241
242 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
243 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
244
245 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
246
247 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
248
249 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
250 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
251 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
252 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
253 must accept this form too.
254
255 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
256 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
257 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100258
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200259 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
260 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
261 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
262 other protocols too.
263
264In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
265mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
266on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
267It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
268specific to the language, framework or application in use.
269
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100270HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100271assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100272
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200273
2741.2.2. The request headers
275--------------------------
276
277The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
278beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
279an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
280Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
281values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
282encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
283the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
284define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
285
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100286Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200287their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100288"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau253c2512020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200289as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
290normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
291representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
292HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200293
294The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
295that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
296is one valid form of empty line.
297
298Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
299headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
300about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
301application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
302
303Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000304 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200305 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
306 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
307 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
308
309
3101.3. HTTP response
311------------------
312
313An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
314messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
315
316 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100317 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200318 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
319 2 Content-length: 350
320 3 Content-Type: text/html
321
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200322As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
323codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
324response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100325continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
326the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
327following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
328sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
329(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
330correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
331such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
332state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
333over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
334if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
335information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200336
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200337
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003381.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200339------------------------
340
341Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
342
343 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
344 - a status code : 200
345 - a reason : OK
346
347The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100348 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
349 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
350 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
351 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
352 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200353
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000354Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100355"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200356found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
357messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
358or "Authentication Required".
359
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100360HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200361
362 Code When / reason
363 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
364 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
365 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
366 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100367 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
368 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200369 400 for an invalid or too large request
370 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
371 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200372 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100373 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200374 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100375 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
376 be available again
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200377 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
378 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
379 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200380 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
382 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
383 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
384
385The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3864.2).
387
388
3891.3.2. The response headers
390---------------------------
391
392Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
393the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
394details.
395
396
3972. Configuring HAProxy
398----------------------
399
4002.1. Configuration file format
401------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200402
403HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
404
405 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
406 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
407 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
408 "frontend" and "backend".
409
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100410The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
411referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200412delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100413
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200414
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004152.2. Quoting and escaping
416-------------------------
417
418HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
419many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
420with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
421single quotes.
422
423If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
424them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
425escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
426
427Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
428
429 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
430 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
431 \\ to use a backslash
432 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
433 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
434
435Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
436the interpretation of:
437
438 space as a parameter separator
439 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
440 # hash as a comment start
441
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200442Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
443-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
444backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
445
446Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200447quoting.
448
449Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
450nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
451
452Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
453equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
454
455 Example:
456 # those are equivalents:
457 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
458 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
459 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
460 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
461 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
462
463 # those are equivalents:
464 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
465 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
466 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
467 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
468
469
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004702.3. Environment variables
471--------------------------
472
473HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
474interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
475configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
476optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
477shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
478underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
479
480 Example:
481
482 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
483
484 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
485
486 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
487
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200488Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
489file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200490
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200491* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
492 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
493
494* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
495 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
496 directory.
497
498* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
499
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500500* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200501 processes, separated by semicolons.
502
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500503* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200504 CLI, separated by semicolons.
505
506See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200507
5082.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200509----------------
510
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100511Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100512values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
513otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
514numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
515for every keyword. Supported units are :
516
517 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
518 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
519 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
520 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
521 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
522 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
523
524
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005252.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200526-------------
527
528 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
529 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
530 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
531 global
532 daemon
533 maxconn 256
534
535 defaults
536 mode http
537 timeout connect 5000ms
538 timeout client 50000ms
539 timeout server 50000ms
540
541 frontend http-in
542 bind *:80
543 default_backend servers
544
545 backend servers
546 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
547
548
549 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
550 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
551 global
552 daemon
553 maxconn 256
554
555 defaults
556 mode http
557 timeout connect 5000ms
558 timeout client 50000ms
559 timeout server 50000ms
560
561 listen http-in
562 bind *:80
563 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
564
565
566Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
567
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100568 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200569
570
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005713. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200572--------------------
573
574Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
575are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
576of them have command-line equivalents.
577
578The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
579
580 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200581 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200582 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200583 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200584 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200585 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200586 - description
587 - deviceatlas-json-file
588 - deviceatlas-log-level
589 - deviceatlas-separator
590 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900591 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200592 - gid
593 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100594 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200595 - h1-case-adjust
596 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100597 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100598 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100599 - issuers-chain-path
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +0200600 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200601 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200602 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100603 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200604 - lua-load
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +0100605 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200606 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200607 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200608 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200609 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200610 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +0200611 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100612 - presetenv
613 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200614 - uid
615 - ulimit-n
616 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200617 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100618 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200619 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200620 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200621 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +0200622 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200623 - ssl-default-bind-options
624 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200625 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200626 - ssl-default-server-options
627 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100628 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +0200629 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100630 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100631 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100632 - 51degrees-data-file
633 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200634 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200635 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200636 - wurfl-data-file
637 - wurfl-information-list
638 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200639 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +0100640 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100641
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200642 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +0100643 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200644 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200645 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200646 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100647 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100648 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100649 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200650 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200651 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200652 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200653 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200654 - noepoll
655 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000656 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200657 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100658 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300659 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000660 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100661 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200662 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200663 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200664 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000665 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000666 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200667 - tune.buffers.limit
668 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200669 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200670 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100671 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +0200672 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200673 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200674 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200675 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100676 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200677 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200678 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +0200679 - tune.idle-pool.shared
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100680 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100681 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100682 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100683 - tune.lua.session-timeout
684 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200685 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100686 - tune.maxaccept
687 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200688 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200689 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200690 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua8e2d972020-07-01 18:27:16 +0200691 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
692 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100693 - tune.rcvbuf.client
694 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100695 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200696 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +0200697 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100698 - tune.sndbuf.client
699 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100700 - tune.ssl.cachesize
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +0200701 - tune.ssl.keylog
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100702 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200703 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100704 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200705 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200706 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100707 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200708 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100709 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200710 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
711 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
712 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100713 - tune.zlib.memlevel
714 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100715
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200716 * Debugging
717 - debug
718 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +0200719 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200720
721
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007223.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200723------------------------------------
724
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200725ca-base <dir>
726 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +0100727 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
728 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
729 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200730
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200731chroot <jail dir>
732 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
733 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
734 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
735 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
736 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100737 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100738
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100739cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
740 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
741 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
742 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
743 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
744 set. These sets have the format
745
746 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
747
748 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100749 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100750 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
751 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100752 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
753 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100754 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100755 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100756 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100757 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100758 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
759 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
760 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
761 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100762
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100763 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
764 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
765 on the machine's word size.
766
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100767 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100768 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
769 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
770 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
771 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
772 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
773 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100774
775 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100776 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
777
778 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
779 # first 4 CPUs
780
781 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
782 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
783 # word size.
784
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100785 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100786 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100787 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
788 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
789 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
790
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100791 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
792 # and so on.
793 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
794 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
795 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
796
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100797 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100798 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
799 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
800 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
801
802 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
803 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
804 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
805
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100806 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
807 # and a thread range.
808 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
809 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
810 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
811
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200812crt-base <dir>
813 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +0100814 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
815 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200816
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200817daemon
818 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
819 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100820 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
821 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200822
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200823deviceatlas-json-file <path>
824 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100825 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200826
827deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100828 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200829 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
830
831deviceatlas-separator <char>
832 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
833 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
834
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100835deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200836 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
837 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
838 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100839
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900840external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100841 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
842 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100843 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
844 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
845 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
846 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
847 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900848
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200849gid <number>
850 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
851 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
852 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100853 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
854 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200855 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100856
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +0100857group <group name>
858 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
859 See also "gid" and "user".
860
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100861hard-stop-after <time>
862 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
863
864 Arguments :
865 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
866 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
867 SIGUSR1 signal.
868
869 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
870 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
871 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
872
873 Example:
874 global
875 hard-stop-after 30s
876
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200877h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
878 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
879 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
880 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
881 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +0500882 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200883 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
884 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
885 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
886 specified in a proxy.
887
888 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
889 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
890 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
891 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
892 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
893 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
894 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
895
896 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
897 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
898 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
899 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
900 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
901
902 Example:
903 global
904 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
905
906 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
907 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
908
909h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
910 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
911 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
912 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
913 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
914 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
915 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
916 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
917 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
918
919 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
920 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
921 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
922
923 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
924 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
925
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100926insecure-fork-wanted
927 By default haproxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
928 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
929 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
930 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
931 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
932 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
933 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
934 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
935 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within haproxy itself
936 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
937 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
938 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
939 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
940 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
941 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
942 disable it.
943
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100944insecure-setuid-wanted
945 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
946 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
947 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
948 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
949 aware of the risks. In a situation where haproxy would need to call external
950 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
951 haproxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
952 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
953 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
954 escalation in such a situation. This is what haproxy does by default. In case
955 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
956 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
957 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
958 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
959
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100960issuers-chain-path <dir>
961 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
962 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
963 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
964 intermediate certificate), haproxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
965 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
966 "issuers-chain-path".
967 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
968 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
969 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
970 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
971 will share the chain in memory.
972
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +0200973localpeer <name>
974 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
975 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
976 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
977 the configuration parsing.
978
979 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
980 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
981
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200982log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
983 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100984 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100985 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100986 configured with "log global".
987
988 <address> can be one of:
989
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100990 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100991 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
992 port).
993
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100994 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
995 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
996 port).
997
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100998 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100999 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1000 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001001 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001002
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001003 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1004 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1005 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1006 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1007 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1008 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1009 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1010 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1011 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1012 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
1013 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
1014 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1015 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1016 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001017 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1018 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001019
1020 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1021 "fd@2", see above.
1022
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001023 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1024 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1025 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1026 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1027 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1028
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001029 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1030 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001031
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001032 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1033 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1034 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1035 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1036 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1037 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1038 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1039 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1040 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1041 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001042 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1043 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001044
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001045 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1046 one of the following :
1047
1048 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
1049 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1050
1051 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1052 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1053
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001054 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
1055 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
1056 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1057 designed to be used with a local log server.
1058
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001059 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1060 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1061 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1062 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1063 logger consumes.
1064
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001065 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1066 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
1067 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1068 used with a local log server.
1069
1070 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
1071 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1072 designed to be used with a local log server.
1073
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001074 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1075 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1076 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1077 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1078
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001079 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1080 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1081 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1082 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1083 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1084
1085 <sample_size>
1086 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1087 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1088 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1089 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1090 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1091
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001092 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001093
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001094 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1095 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1096 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1097
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001098 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1099 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1100 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1101 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001102
1103 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001104 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1105 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1106 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1107 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1108 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1109 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001110
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001111 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001112
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001113log-send-hostname [<string>]
1114 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1115 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1116 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1117 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1118 the logs.
1119
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001120log-tag <string>
1121 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1122 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1123 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001124 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001125
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001126lua-load <file>
1127 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
1128 used multiple times.
1129
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001130lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1131 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1132 variable.
1133 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1134 to "path".
1135
1136 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1137 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1138 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1139 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1140 will be checked earlier.
1141
1142 As an example by specifying the following path:
1143
1144 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1145 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1146
1147 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1148 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1149 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1150 paths if that does not exist either.
1151
1152 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1153 documentation.
1154
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001155master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001156 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1157 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1158 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001159 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001160 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1161 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001162 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1163 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1164 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1165 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1166 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001167
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001168 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001169
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001170mworker-max-reloads <number>
1171 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001172 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001173 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1174 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1175 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1176
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001177nbproc <number>
1178 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1179 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1180 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001181 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1182 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreau1f672a82019-01-26 14:20:55 +01001183 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon" and
1184 "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001185
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001186nbthread <number>
1187 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001188 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1189 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1190 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1191 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1192 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001193 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1194 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1195 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1196 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1197 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1198 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1199 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001200
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001201pidfile <pidfile>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001202 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001203 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
1204 starting the process. See also "daemon".
1205
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001206pp2-never-send-local
1207 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
1208 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
1209 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
1210 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
1211 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
1212 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
1213 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
1214 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
1215 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
1216 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
1217 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
1218
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001219presetenv <name> <value>
1220 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1221 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1222 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1223 and "unsetenv".
1224
1225resetenv [<name> ...]
1226 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1227 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1228 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1229 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1230 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1231 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1232 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1233 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1234
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001235stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001236 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1237 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1238 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1239 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1240 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1241 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001242 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001243 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1244 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1245 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1246 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001247
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001248server-state-base <directory>
1249 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001250 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1251 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001252
1253server-state-file <file>
1254 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1255 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1256 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1257 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1258 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1259 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1260 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1261 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001262 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1263 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001264
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001265setenv <name> <value>
1266 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1267 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1268 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1269 and "unsetenv".
1270
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001271set-dumpable
1272 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001273 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1274 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1275 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1276 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1277 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1278 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1279 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1280 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1281 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1282 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1283 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1284 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1285 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1286 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1287 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
1288 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it
1289 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001290
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001291ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1292 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1293 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001294 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001295 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001296 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1297 information and recommendations see e.g.
1298 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1299 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1300 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1301 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001302
1303ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1304 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1305 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1306 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1307 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1308 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001309 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1310 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1311 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001312 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001313
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001314ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
1315 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1316 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
1317 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
1318 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
1319 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1320
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001321ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1322 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1323 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1324 keyword to see available options.
1325
1326 Example:
1327 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001328 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001329
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001330ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1331 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1332 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001333 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001334 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001335 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1336 information and recommendations see e.g.
1337 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1338 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1339 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1340 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1341 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001342
1343ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1344 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1345 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1346 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1347 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1348 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001349 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1350 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1351 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1352 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001353
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001354ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1355 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1356 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1357 keyword to see available options.
1358
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001359ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1360 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1361 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1362 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001363 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001364 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001365 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1366 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1367 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1368 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001369 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1370 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1371 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1372
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001373ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001374 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
1375 the loading of the SSL certificates.
1376
1377 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1378 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1379 optimize the startup time.
1380
1381 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1382 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1383 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1384
1385 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001386 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001387
1388 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
1389 will try to load a certificate bundle. This is done by looking for
1390 <basename>.rsa, .ecdsa and .dsa. In the case of directories, HAProxy will
1391 try to gather the files with the same basename in a multi-certificate bundle.
1392 The bundles were introduced with OpenSSL 1.0.2 and were the only way back
1393 then to load an ECDSA certificate and a RSA one, with the same SNI. Since
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001394 OpenSSL 1.1.1 it is not recommended anymore, you can specify both the ECDSA
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001395 and the RSA file on the bind line.
1396
1397 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword.
1398
1399 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword.
1400
1401 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
1402 not provided in the PEM file.
1403
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001404 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
1405 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
1406
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001407 The default behavior is "all".
1408
1409 Example:
1410 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
1411 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
1412 ssl-load-extra-files none
1413
1414 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options.
1415
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001416ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1417 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1418 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1419 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1420
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001421ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04001422 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the anchor for chain validation: as a
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001423 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
1424 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
1425 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
1426 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
1427 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
1428 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
1429 bits does not need it.
1430
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001431stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1432 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1433 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1434 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001435 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001436 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001437
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001438 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1439 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1440 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001441
1442stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1443 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1444 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001445 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001446
1447stats maxconn <connections>
1448 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1449 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1450
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001451uid <number>
1452 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1453 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1454 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1455 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1456
1457ulimit-n <number>
1458 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1459 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1460 option.
1461
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001462unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1463 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1464
1465 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1466 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1467 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1468 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1469 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1470 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1471 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1472 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1473 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1474 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1475
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001476unsetenv [<name> ...]
1477 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1478 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1479 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1480 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1481 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1482 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1483 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1484
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001485user <user name>
1486 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1487 See also "uid" and "group".
1488
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001489node <name>
1490 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1491
1492 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1493 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1494 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1495 traffic.
1496
1497description <text>
1498 Add a text that describes the instance.
1499
1500 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1501 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1502 "<" and ">" characters.
1503
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100150451degrees-data-file <file path>
1505 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001506 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001507
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001508 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001509 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1510
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000151151degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001512 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1513 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1514 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1515
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001516 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001517 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1518
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200151951degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001520 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1521 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1522
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001523 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1524 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1525
152651degrees-cache-size <number>
1527 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1528 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1529 By default, this cache is disabled.
1530
1531 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001532 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1533
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001534wurfl-data-file <file path>
1535 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1536 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1537
1538 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1539 with USE_WURFL=1.
1540
1541wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1542 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1543 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1544 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1545
1546 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1547
1548 Valid WURFL properties are:
1549 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1550
1551 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1552 device.
1553
1554 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1555 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1556
1557 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1558 particular web request.
1559
1560 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1561 used Libwurfl API version.
1562
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001563 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1564 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1565
1566 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1567 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1568
1569 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1570
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001571 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1572 with USE_WURFL=1.
1573
1574wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1575 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1576 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1577
1578 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1579 with USE_WURFL=1.
1580
1581wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1582 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1583 thus before the chroot.
1584
1585 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1586 with USE_WURFL=1.
1587
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001588wurfl-cache-size <size>
1589 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1590 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001591 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001592 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001593
1594 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1595 with USE_WURFL=1.
1596
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001597strict-limits
William Dauchya5194602020-03-28 19:29:58 +01001598 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. Haproxy tries to set the
1599 best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it will
1600 emit a warning. This option is here to guarantee an explicit failure of
1601 haproxy when those limits fail. It is enabled by default. It may still be
1602 forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001603
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016043.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001605-----------------------
1606
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001607busy-polling
1608 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1609 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1610 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1611 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1612 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1613 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1614 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1615 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1616 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1617 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1618 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1619 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1620 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1621 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1622 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1623 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1624 "poll" pollers.
1625
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01001626 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
1627 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
1628 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
1629
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001630max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1631 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1632 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1633 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1634 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1635 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1636 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1637 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1638 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1639
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001640maxconn <number>
1641 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1642 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1643 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001644 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1645 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1646 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1647 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001648 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1649 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1650 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1651 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1652 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1653 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001654
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001655maxconnrate <number>
1656 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1657 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1658 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1659 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1660 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1661 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1662 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1663 fairness.
1664
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001665maxcomprate <number>
1666 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001667 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001668 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1669 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1670 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001671 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001672 default value.
1673
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001674maxcompcpuusage <number>
1675 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1676 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1677 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1678 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1679 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1680 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1681 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1682 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1683
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001684maxpipes <number>
1685 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1686 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1687 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1688 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1689 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1690 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1691
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001692maxsessrate <number>
1693 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1694 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1695 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1696 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1697 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1698 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1699 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1700 fairness.
1701
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001702maxsslconn <number>
1703 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1704 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1705 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1706 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1707 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1708 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1709 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001710 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1711 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1712 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1713 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1714 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1715 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1716 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001717
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001718maxsslrate <number>
1719 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1720 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1721 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1722 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1723 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1724 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1725 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1726 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1727 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1728 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1729
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001730maxzlibmem <number>
1731 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1732 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1733 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001734 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1735 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1736 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1737
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001738noepoll
1739 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1740 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001741 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001742
1743nokqueue
1744 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1745 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1746 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1747
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001748noevports
1749 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
1750 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
1751 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
1752 also "nopoll".
1753
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001754nopoll
1755 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1756 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001757 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001758 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
1759 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001760
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001761nosplice
1762 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001763 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001764 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001765 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001766 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1767 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1768 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1769 "option splice-response".
1770
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001771nogetaddrinfo
1772 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1773 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1774
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001775noreuseport
1776 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1777 command line argument "-dR".
1778
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001779profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
1780 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
1781 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
1782 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
1783 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001784 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001785 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
1786 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
1787 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
1788 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
1789
1790 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
1791 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
1792 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
1793 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
1794 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001795 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1796 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1797 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1798 CLI.
1799
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001800spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001801 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1802 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1803 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1804 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1805 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1806 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001807
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001808ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001809 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001810 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001811 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1812 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1813 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1814 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1815 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001816 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1817 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001818 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1819 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1820 openssl configuration file uses:
1821 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1822
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001823ssl-mode-async
1824 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001825 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001826 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1827 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1828 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001829 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001830 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001831
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001832tune.buffers.limit <number>
1833 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1834 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1835 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1836 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1837 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001838 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001839 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1840 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1841 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1842 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1843 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1844 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1845 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1846 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1847 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1848
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001849tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1850 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1851 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1852 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1853 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1854
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001855tune.bufsize <number>
1856 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1857 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1858 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1859 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1860 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1861 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1862 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001863 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1864 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1865 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001866 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01001867 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
1868 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
1869 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001870
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001871tune.chksize <number>
1872 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1873 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1874 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1875 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1876 checks whenever possible.
1877
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001878tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1879 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1880 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1881 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1882 this value. The default value is 1.
1883
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01001884tune.fail-alloc
1885 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
1886 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
1887 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
1888 gracefully.
1889
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02001890tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
1891 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
1892 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
1893 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
1894 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
1895 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
1896
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001897tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1898 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1899 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1900 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1901 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1902 change it.
1903
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001904tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1905 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001906 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1907 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001908 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1909 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1910 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1911 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1912 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1913
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001914tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1915 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1916 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1917 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1918 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1919 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1920 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1921 recommended not to change this value.
1922
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01001923tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
1924 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
1925 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
1926 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
1927 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
1928 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
1929 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
1930 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
1931
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001932tune.http.cookielen <number>
1933 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1934 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1935 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1936 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1937 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1938 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1939 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1940 to change this value.
1941
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001942tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001943 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1944 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001945 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001946 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001947 configuration directives too.
1948 The default value is 1024.
1949
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001950tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1951 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1952 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1953 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1954 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1955 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1956 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001957 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1958 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1959 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001960
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02001961tune.idle-pool.shared { on | off }
1962 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') sharing of idle connection pools between
1963 threads for a same server. The default is to share them between threads in
1964 order to minimize the number of persistent connections to a server, and to
1965 optimize the connection reuse rate. But to help with debugging or when
1966 suspecting a bug in HAProxy around connection reuse, it can be convenient to
1967 forcefully disable this idle pool sharing between multiple threads, and force
1968 this option to "off". The default is on.
1969
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001970tune.idletimer <timeout>
1971 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1972 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1973 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1974 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1975 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1976 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001977 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001978 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001979 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1980
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01001981tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
1982 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
1983 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
1984 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
1985 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
1986 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
1987 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
1988 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
1989 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
1990 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
1991
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001992tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1993 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001994 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001995 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1996 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001997 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001998 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1999 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
2000
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01002001tune.lua.maxmem
2002 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
2003 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
2004 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
2005 memory.
2006
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002007tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
2008 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002009 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2010 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002011 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002012
2013tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
2014 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
2015 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
2016 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
2017 check servers.
2018
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002019tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
2020 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
2021 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2022 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002023 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002024
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002025tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01002026 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
2027 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
2028 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
2029 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
2030 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
2031 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
2032 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
2033 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
2034 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
2035 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002036
2037tune.maxpollevents <number>
2038 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
2039 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
2040 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
2041 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
2042 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
2043
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002044tune.maxrewrite <number>
2045 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
2046 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
2047 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
2048 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
2049 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
2050 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
2051 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
2052 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
2053 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2054 bufsize.
2055
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002056tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2057 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2058 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2059 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2060 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2061 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2062 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2063 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2064 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2065 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002066 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2067 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002068 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2069 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2070 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2071 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2072 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2073 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2074 setting this parameter to 0.
2075
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002076tune.pipesize <number>
2077 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2078 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2079 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2080 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2081 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2082 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2083
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002084tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2085 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2086 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2087 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2088 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2089 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2090 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002091 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002092
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002093tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2094 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2095 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2096 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2097 default is 20.
2098
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002099tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2100tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2101 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2102 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2103 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002104 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002105 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002106 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2107 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2108
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002109tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002110 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002111 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2112 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2113 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2114 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2115
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002116tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002117 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002118 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002119 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead. When
2120 experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
2121 tune.sched.low-latency to limit the maximum latency to the lowest possible.
2122
2123tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
2124 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
2125 haproxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
2126 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
2127 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
2128 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
2129 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
2130 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
2131 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
2132 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002133
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002134tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2135tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2136 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2137 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2138 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002139 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002140 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002141 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2142 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2143 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2144 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
2145 notifying haproxy again.
2146
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002147tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002148 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
2149 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
2150 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002151 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002152 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002153 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002154 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
2155 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
2156 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01002157 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
2158 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002159
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002160tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002161 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002162 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2163 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2164 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2165 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2166 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2167
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002168tune.ssl.keylog { on | off }
2169 This option activates the logging of the TLS keys. It should be used with
2170 care as it will consume more memory per SSL session and could decrease
2171 performances. This is disabled by default.
2172
2173 These sample fetches should be used to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE that is
2174 required to decipher traffic with wireshark.
2175
2176 https://developer.mozilla.org/en-US/docs/Mozilla/Projects/NSS/Key_Log_Format
2177
2178 The SSLKEYLOG is a series of lines which are formatted this way:
2179
2180 <Label> <space> <ClientRandom> <space> <Secret>
2181
2182 The ClientRandom is provided by the %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] sample
2183 fetch, the secret and the Label could be find in the array below. You need
2184 to generate a SSLKEYLOGFILE with all the labels in this array.
2185
2186 The following sample fetches are hexadecimal strings and does not need to be
2187 converted.
2188
2189 SSLKEYLOGFILE Label | Sample fetches for the Secrets
2190 --------------------------------|-----------------------------------------
2191 CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret]
2192 CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret]
2193 SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret]
2194 CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0]
2195 SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0]
William Lallemandd742b6c2020-07-07 10:14:56 +02002196 EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_exporter_secret]
2197 EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret]
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002198
2199 This is only available with OpenSSL 1.1.1, and useful with TLS1.3 session.
2200
2201 If you want to generate the content of a SSLKEYLOGFILE with TLS < 1.3, you
2202 only need this line:
2203
2204 "CLIENT_RANDOM %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] %[ssl_fc_session_key,hex]"
2205
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002206tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2207 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002208 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002209 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2210 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2211 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2212 being used for too long.
2213
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002214tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2215 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2216 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2217 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2218 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2219 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2220 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2221 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2222 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2223 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2224 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002225 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002226 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002227
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002228tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2229 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2230 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2231 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2232 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
Willy Tarreau3ba77d22020-05-08 09:31:18 +02002233 this maximum value. Default value if 2048. Only 1024 or higher values are
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002234 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2235 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002236 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2237 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002238
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002239tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2240 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2241 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2242 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2243 1000 entries.
2244
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002245tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2246 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
2247 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
2248 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2249
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002250tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002251tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002252tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2253tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2254tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002255 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2256 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2257 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2258 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2259 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2260 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2261 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2262 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002263
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002264 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2265 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2266 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2267 all available space is consumed.
2268 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2269 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2270 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002271
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002272tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2273 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002274 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002275 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002276 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002277 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2278
2279tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2280 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2281 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002282 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2283 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002284
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022853.3. Debugging
2286--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002287
Willy Tarreau1b857852020-02-25 11:27:22 +01002288debug (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002289 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
2290 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
2291 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
2292 system startup.
2293
2294quiet
2295 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2296 line argument "-q".
2297
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002298zero-warning
2299 When this option is set, haproxy will refuse to start if any warning was
2300 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2301 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2302 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2303 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2304 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
2305
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002306
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010023073.4. Userlists
2308--------------
2309It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2310http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2311it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2312
2313userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002314 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002315 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2316
2317group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002318 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002319 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2320 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2321
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002322user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2323 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002324 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2325 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002326 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2327 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2328 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2329 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002330
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002331 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2332 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2333 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2334 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2335 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2336 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2337 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2338 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2339 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002340
2341 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002342 userlist L1
2343 group G1 users tiger,scott
2344 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002345
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002346 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2347 user scott insecure-password elgato
2348 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002349
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002350 userlist L2
2351 group G1
2352 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002353
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002354 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2355 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2356 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002357
2358 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002359
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002360
23613.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002362----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002363It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2364several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2365instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2366values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2367automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2368In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2369using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2370tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2371reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2372Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2373that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2374each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002375
2376peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002377 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002378 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2379
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002380bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2381 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2382 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2383
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002384disabled
2385 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2386 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2387 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2388
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002389default-bind [param*]
2390 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2391
2392default-server [param*]
2393 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2394
2395 Arguments:
2396 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2397 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2398 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2399 details.
2400
2401
2402 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2403
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002404enable
2405 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2406
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01002407log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
2408 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2409 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
2410 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
2411 more details.
2412
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002413peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002414 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2415 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002416 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
2417 haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on <ip>:<port>.
2418 Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to in order to join the
2419 remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
2420 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002421
2422 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2423 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2424
2425 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002426 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
2427 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
2428 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002429
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002430 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2431 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002432
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002433 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2434 "server" keyword explanation below).
2435
2436server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002437 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002438 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2439 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2440 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2441 of this "peers" section).
2442 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2443
2444
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002445 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002446 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002447 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002448 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2449 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2450 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002451
2452 backend mybackend
2453 mode tcp
2454 balance roundrobin
2455 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2456 stick on src
2457
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002458 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2459 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002460
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002461 Example:
2462 peers mypeers
2463 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2464 default-server ssl verify none
2465 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2466 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002467
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002468
2469table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2470 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2471
2472 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2473 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002474 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002475 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2476 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2477 "stick-table" keyword).
2478
2479 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2480 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2481 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2482 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2483 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2484 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2485 of the stick-table name as follows:
2486
2487 peers mypeers
2488 peer A ...
2489 peer B ...
2490 table t1 ...
2491
2492 frontend fe1
2493 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2494
2495 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2496 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2497
2498 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2499 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2500 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2501 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2502 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2503 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2504 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2505
2506 peers mypeers
2507 peer A ...
2508 peer B ...
2509 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2510
2511 backend t1
2512 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2513
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002514 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002515 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2516 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2517
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090025183.6. Mailers
2519------------
2520It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2521If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2522in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2523
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002524mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002525 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2526 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2527
2528mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2529 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2530
2531 Example:
2532 mailers mymailers
2533 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2534 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2535
2536 backend mybackend
2537 mode tcp
2538 balance roundrobin
2539
2540 email-alert mailers mymailers
2541 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2542 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2543
2544 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2545 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2546
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002547timeout mail <time>
2548 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2549 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2550 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2551 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2552
2553 Example:
2554 mailers mymailers
2555 timeout mail 20s
2556 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002557
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020025583.7. Programs
2559-------------
2560In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2561master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2562managed the same way as the workers.
2563
2564During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2565sequence as a worker:
2566
2567 - the master is re-executed
2568 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2569 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2570 instance of the program
2571
2572During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2573
2574program <name>
2575 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2576 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2577 the management guide).
2578
2579command <command> [arguments*]
2580 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2581 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2582 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2583 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2584
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08002585user <user name>
2586 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2587 See also "group".
2588
2589group <group name>
2590 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
2591 See also "user".
2592
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02002593option start-on-reload
2594no option start-on-reload
2595 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
2596 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
2597 program section.
2598
2599
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010026003.8. HTTP-errors
2601----------------
2602
2603It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
2604imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
2605several places and can be fully or partially imported.
2606
2607http-errors <name>
2608 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
2609 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
2610
2611errorfile <code> <file>
2612 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
2613
2614 Arguments :
2615 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02002616 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
2617 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002618
2619 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
2620 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
2621 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
2622 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2623 before any chroot is performed.
2624
2625 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
2626
2627 Example:
2628 http-errors website-1
2629 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
2630 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
2631 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2632
2633 http-errors website-2
2634 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
2635 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
2636 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2637
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020026383.9. Rings
2639----------
2640
2641It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
2642servers or traces.
2643
2644ring <ringname>
2645 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
2646
2647description <text>
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002648 The description is an optional description string of the ring. It will
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002649 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
2650
2651format <format>
2652 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
2653
2654 Arguments:
2655 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
2656 one of the following :
2657
2658 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
2659 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
2660 designed to be used with a local log server.
2661
2662 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
2663 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
2664 used in containers or during development, where the severity
2665 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
2666 is the default.
2667
2668 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
2669 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
2670
2671 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
2672 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
2673
2674 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
2675 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
2676 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
2677 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
2678 logger consumes.
2679
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02002680 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between angle
2681 brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time,
2682 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used
2683 with a local log server.
2684
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002685 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
2686 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
2687 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
2688 used with a local log server.
2689
2690maxlen <length>
2691 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
2692 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
2693 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
2694
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002695server <name> <address> [param*]
2696 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
2697 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
2698 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
2699 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
2700 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
2701 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
2702 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
2703 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
2704 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02002705 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
2706 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002707
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002708size <size>
2709 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
2710 set to BUFSIZE.
2711
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002712timeout connect <timeout>
2713 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2714
2715 Arguments :
2716 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
2717 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2718 as explained at the top of this document.
2719
2720timeout server <timeout>
2721 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
2722
2723 Arguments :
2724 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
2725 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2726 as explained at the top of this document.
2727
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002728 Example:
2729 global
2730 log ring@myring local7
2731
2732 ring myring
2733 description "My local buffer"
2734 format rfc3164
2735 maxlen 1200
2736 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002737 timeout connect 5s
2738 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02002739 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002740
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +020027413.10. Log forwarding
2742-------------------
2743
2744It is possible to declare one or multiple log forwarding section,
2745haproxy will forward all received log messages to a log servers list.
2746
2747log-forward <name>
2748 Creates a new log forwarder proxy identified as <name>.
2749
2750bind <addr> [param*]
2751 Used to configure a log udp listener to receive messages to forward.
2752 Only udp listeners are allowed, address must be prefixed using
2753 'udp@', 'udp4@' or 'udp6@'. This supports for all "bind" parameters
2754 found in 5.1 paragraph but most of them are irrelevant for udp/syslog case.
2755
2756log global
2757log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
2758 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2759 Used to configure target log servers. See more details on proxies
2760 documentation.
2761 If no format specified, haproxy tries to keep the incoming log format.
2762 Configured facility is ignored, except if incoming message does not
2763 present a facility but one is mandatory on the outgoing format.
2764 If there is no timestamp available in the input format, but the field
2765 exists in output format, haproxy will use the local date.
2766
2767 Example:
2768 global
2769 log stderr format iso local7
2770
2771 ring myring
2772 description "My local buffer"
2773 format rfc5424
2774 maxlen 1200
2775 size 32764
2776 timeout connect 5s
2777 timeout server 10s
2778 # syslog tcp server
2779 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:514 log-proto octet-count
2780
2781 log-forward sylog-loadb
2782 bind udp4@127.0.0.1:1514
2783 # all messages on stderr
2784 log global
2785 # all messages on local tcp syslog server
2786 log ring@myring local0
2787 # load balance messages on 4 udp syslog servers
2788 log 127.0.0.1:10001 sample 1:4 local0
2789 log 127.0.0.1:10002 sample 2:4 local0
2790 log 127.0.0.1:10003 sample 3:4 local0
2791 log 127.0.0.1:10004 sample 4:4 local0
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002792
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020027934. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002794----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002795
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002796Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02002797 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002798 - frontend <name>
2799 - backend <name>
2800 - listen <name>
2801
2802A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2803its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2804section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002805section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002806
2807A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2808connections.
2809
2810A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2811to forward incoming connections.
2812
2813A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2814parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2815
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002816All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2817'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2818case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2819
2820Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2821logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2822proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2823However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2824name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2825
2826Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2827and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002828bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002829protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2830modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2831arbitrary criteria.
2832
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002833In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2834a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01002835the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002836
2837 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2838 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2839 between responses and new requests.
2840
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002841 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2842 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2843 client-facing connection remains open.
2844
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002845 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2846 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002847
2848The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2849frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2850following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002851weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002852
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002853 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002854
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002855 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2856 ----+-----+-----+----
2857 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2858 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002859 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2860 ----+-----+-----+----
2861 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002862
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002863
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002864
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020028654.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2866--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002867
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002868The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2869limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2870they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2871limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002872marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002873option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002874and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2875with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2876specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002877
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002878
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002879 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2880------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2881acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002882backlog X X X -
2883balance X - X X
2884bind - X X -
2885bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002886capture cookie - X X -
2887capture request header - X X -
2888capture response header - X X -
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09002889clitcpka-cnt X X X -
2890clitcpka-idle X X X -
2891clitcpka-intvl X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002892compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002893cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002894declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002895default-server X - X X
2896default_backend X X X -
2897description - X X X
2898disabled X X X X
2899dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002900email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002901email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002902email-alert mailers X X X X
2903email-alert myhostname X X X X
2904email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002905enabled X X X X
2906errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002907errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002908errorloc X X X X
2909errorloc302 X X X X
2910-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2911errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002912force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002913filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002914fullconn X - X X
2915grace X X X X
2916hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01002917http-after-response - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02002918http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02002919http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002920http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02002921http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02002922http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002923http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02002924http-check set-var X - X X
2925http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02002926http-error X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002927http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002928http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002929http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002930http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002931id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002932ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002933load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002934log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002935log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002936log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002937log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002938max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002939maxconn X X X -
2940mode X X X X
2941monitor fail - X X -
2942monitor-net X X X -
2943monitor-uri X X X -
2944option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2945option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2946option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2947option allbackups (*) X - X X
2948option checkcache (*) X - X X
2949option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2950option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02002951option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002952option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2953option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002954-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2955option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02002956option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
2957option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002958option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002959option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002960option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002961option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02002962option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002963option http-server-close (*) X X X X
2964option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
2965option httpchk X - X X
2966option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01002967option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002968option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002969option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002970option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002971option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002972option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2973option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2974option logasap (*) X X X -
2975option mysql-check X - X X
2976option nolinger (*) X X X X
2977option originalto X X X X
2978option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002979option pgsql-check X - X X
2980option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002981option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002982option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002983option smtpchk X - X X
2984option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2985option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2986option splice-request (*) X X X X
2987option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002988option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002989option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2990option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2991-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002992option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002993option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2994option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2995option tcpka X X X X
2996option tcplog X X X X
2997option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002998external-check command X - X X
2999external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003000persist rdp-cookie X - X X
3001rate-limit sessions X X X -
3002redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003003-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003004retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02003005retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003006server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003007server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02003008server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003009source X - X X
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003010srvtcpka-cnt X - X X
3011srvtcpka-idle X - X X
3012srvtcpka-intvl X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02003013stats admin - X X X
3014stats auth X X X X
3015stats enable X X X X
3016stats hide-version X X X X
3017stats http-request - X X X
3018stats realm X X X X
3019stats refresh X X X X
3020stats scope X X X X
3021stats show-desc X X X X
3022stats show-legends X X X X
3023stats show-node X X X X
3024stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003025-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3026stick match - - X X
3027stick on - - X X
3028stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02003029stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01003030stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003031tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003032tcp-check connect X - X X
3033tcp-check expect X - X X
3034tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003035tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003036tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003037tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003038tcp-check set-var X - X X
3039tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02003040tcp-request connection - X X -
3041tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02003042tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02003043tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02003044tcp-response content - - X X
3045tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003046timeout check X - X X
3047timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003048timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003049timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003050timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
3051timeout http-request X X X X
3052timeout queue X - X X
3053timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003054timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003055timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003056timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003057transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01003058unique-id-format X X X -
3059unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003060use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02003061use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02003062use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003063------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3064 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003065
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003066
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020030674.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
3068---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003069
3070This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
3071
3072
3073acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
3074 Declare or complete an access list.
3075 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3076 no | yes | yes | yes
3077 Example:
3078 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
3079 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
3080 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
3081
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003082 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003083
3084
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003085backlog <conns>
3086 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3087 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3088 yes | yes | yes | no
3089 Arguments :
3090 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
3091 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003092 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003093
3094 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
3095 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
3096 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
3097 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
3098 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
3099 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
3100 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
3101 backlog parameter.
3102
3103 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
3104 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
3105 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
3106
3107 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
3108
3109
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003110balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003111balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003112 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
3113 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3114 yes | no | yes | yes
3115 Arguments :
3116 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
3117 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
3118 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
3119 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
3120
3121 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3122 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
3123 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
3124 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003125 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08003126 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003127 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
3128 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
3129 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
3130 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
3131 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
3132 it, so that you don't worry.
3133
3134 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3135 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
3136 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
3137 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
3138 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
3139 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
3140 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
3141 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003142
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003143 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
3144 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
3145 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
3146 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
3147 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
3148 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
3149 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
3150 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
3151
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003152 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003153 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003154 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
3155 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003156 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003157 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
3158 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
3159 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
3160 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
3161 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003162 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
3163 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
3164 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
3165 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
3166 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
3167 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003168
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003169 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
3170 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
3171 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
3172 address will always reach the same server as long as no
3173 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
3174 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
3175 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
3176 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003177 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003178 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003179 static by default, which means that changing a server's
3180 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
3181 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003182
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003183 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
3184 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
3185 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
3186 the running servers. The result designates which server will
3187 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
3188 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
3189 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
3190 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
3191 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
3192 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3193 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3194 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003195
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003196 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003197 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
3198 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
3199 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
3200 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
3201 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
3202 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
3203 URIs start with a leading "/".
3204
3205 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
3206 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
3207 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
3208 evaluation stops when either is reached.
3209
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003210 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003211 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
3212
3213 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003214 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
3215 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003216 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
3217 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
3218 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
3219 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003220 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003221 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
3222 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003223
3224 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
3225 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
3226 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
3227 server will receive the request.
3228
3229 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
3230 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
3231 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
3232 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
3233 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003234 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
3235 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
3236 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003237
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003238 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
3239 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
3240 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
3241 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
3242 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003243
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003244 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003245 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
3246 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
3247 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
3248
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003249 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3250 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3251 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3252
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003253 random
3254 random(<draws>)
3255 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003256 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
3257 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
3258 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
3259 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003260 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
3261 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
3262 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
3263 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
3264 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
3265 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
3266 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
3267 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
3268 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
3269 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
3270 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
3271 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
3272 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
3273 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
3274 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
3275 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
3276 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
3277 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
3278 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
3279 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003280
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003281 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02003282 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003283 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
3284 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
3285 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
3286 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
3287 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
3288 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003289 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003290 used instead.
3291
3292 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
3293 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
3294 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
3295 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
3296
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003297 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3298 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3299 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3300
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003301 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09003302
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003303 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003304 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
3305 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003306
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01003307 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
3308 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
3309 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003310
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003311 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003312 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003313 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
3314 NTLM relies on.
3315
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003316 Examples :
3317 balance roundrobin
3318 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003319 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003320 balance hdr(User-Agent)
3321 balance hdr(host)
3322 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003323
3324 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
3325 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
3326
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003327 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003328 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
3329 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
3330 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02003331 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003332
3333 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
3334 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
3335 defaults to 16 kB.
3336
3337 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
3338 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
3339
3340 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
3341 Round Robin.
3342
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00003343 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003344 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
3345 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
3346 actually appeared in the first chunk).
3347
3348 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
3349
3350 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003351 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003352 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
3353 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
3354 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003355
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003356 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003357
3358
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003359bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
3360bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003361 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
3362 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3363 no | yes | yes | no
3364 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003365 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
3366 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
3367 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
3368 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01003369 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003370 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
3371 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
3372 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
3373 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
3374 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
3375 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003376 - 'udp@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 or IPv6 and
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003377 protocol UDP is used. Currently those listeners are
3378 supported only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003379 - 'udp4@' -> address is always IPv4 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003380 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
3381 only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003382 - 'udp6@' -> address is always IPv6 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003383 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
3384 only in log-forward sections.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003385 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02003386 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
3387 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
3388 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
3389 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
3390 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
3391 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
3392 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01003393 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
3394 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
3395 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02003396 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
3397 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
3398 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
3399 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003400 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
3401 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
3402 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003403
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003404 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
3405 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003406 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
3407 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
3408 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003409 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
3410 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
3411 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
3412 the range.
3413
3414 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
3415 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
3416 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
3417 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
3418 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
3419 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
3420 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003421 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003422 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003423
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003424 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003425 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003426 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
3427 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
3428 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
3429 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
3430 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
3431 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
3432
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003433 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
3434 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
3435 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
3436 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003437
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003438 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
3439 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
3440 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
3441 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
3442 in a frontend.
3443
3444 Example :
3445 listen http_proxy
3446 bind :80,:443
3447 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003448 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003449
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003450 listen http_https_proxy
3451 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02003452 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003453
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003454 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
3455 bind ipv6@:80
3456 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
3457 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
3458
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003459 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003460 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003461
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02003462 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
3463 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
3464 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
3465 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
3466 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
3467
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003468 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003469 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003470
3471
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003472bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003473 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
3474 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3475 yes | yes | yes | yes
3476 Arguments :
3477 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
3478 may be used to override a default value.
3479
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003480 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003481 option may be combined with other numbers.
3482
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003483 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003484 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
3485 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
3486 missing from all processes.
3487
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003488 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003489 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003490 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
3491 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
3492 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
3493 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
3494 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02003495 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003496
3497 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
3498 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
3499 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
3500 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
3501 and 'even' instances.
3502
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003503 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
3504 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
3505 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
3506 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003507
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003508 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
3509 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
3510
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02003511 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
3512 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
3513 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
3514
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003515 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
3516 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
3517
3518 Example :
3519 listen app_ip1
3520 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003521 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003522
3523 listen app_ip2
3524 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003525 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003526
3527 listen management
3528 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003529 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003530
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01003531 listen management
3532 bind 10.0.0.4:80
3533 bind-process 1-4
3534
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003535 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003536
3537
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003538capture cookie <name> len <length>
3539 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
3540 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3541 no | yes | yes | no
3542 Arguments :
3543 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
3544 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
3545 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
3546 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003547 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003548
3549 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
3550 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
3551 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
3552 right if it exceeds <length>.
3553
3554 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
3555 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
3556 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
3557 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
3558
3559 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
3560 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
3561 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
3562
3563 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
3564 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
3565 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003566 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
3567 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
3568 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003569
3570 Example:
3571 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
3572
3573 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003574 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003575
3576
3577capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003578 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003579 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3580 no | yes | yes | no
3581 Arguments :
3582 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003583 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003584 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
3585 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3586 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3587
3588 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3589 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3590 it exceeds <length>.
3591
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003592 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003593 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
3594 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003595 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
3596 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
3597 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
3598 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003599 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003600 environments to find where the request came from.
3601
3602 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
3603 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
3604 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
3605 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003606
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003607 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
3608 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3609 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3610 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3611 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003612
3613 Example:
3614 capture request header Host len 15
3615 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003616 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003617
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003618 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003619 about logging.
3620
3621
3622capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003623 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003624 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3625 no | yes | yes | no
3626 Arguments :
3627 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003628 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003629 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3630 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3631 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3632
3633 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3634 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3635 it exceeds <length>.
3636
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003637 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003638 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3639 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3640 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003641 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3642 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3643 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3644 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003645
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003646 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3647 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3648 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3649 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3650 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003651
3652 Example:
3653 capture response header Content-length len 9
3654 capture response header Location len 15
3655
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003656 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003657 about logging.
3658
3659
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003660clitcpka-cnt <count>
3661 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
3662 the connection on the client side.
3663 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3664 yes | yes | yes | no
3665 Arguments :
3666 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
3667
3668 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
3669 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02003670 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
3671 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003672
3673 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-idle", "clitcpka-intvl".
3674
3675
3676clitcpka-idle <timeout>
3677 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
3678 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
3679 client side.
3680 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3681 yes | yes | yes | no
3682 Arguments :
3683 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
3684 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
3685 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
3686 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
3687
3688 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
3689 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02003690 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
3691 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003692
3693 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-intvl".
3694
3695
3696clitcpka-intvl <timeout>
3697 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the client side.
3698 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3699 yes | yes | yes | no
3700 Arguments :
3701 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
3702 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
3703 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
3704 document.
3705
3706 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
3707 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02003708 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
3709 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003710
3711 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-idle".
3712
3713
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003714compression algo <algorithm> ...
3715compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003716compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003717 Enable HTTP compression.
3718 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3719 yes | yes | yes | yes
3720 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003721 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
3722 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
3723 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
3724
3725 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003726 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
3727 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
3728 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003729
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003730 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003731 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003732
3733 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
3734 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
3735 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
3736 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
3737 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003738 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003739
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003740 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
3741 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
3742 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
3743 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
3744 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
3745 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
3746 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003747 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003748
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003749 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003750 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003751 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3752 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3753 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3754 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3755 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003756
3757 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3758 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3759 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3760 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3761 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003762 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3763 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3764 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3765 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3766 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003767 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3768 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003769
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003770 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003771 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3772 "Accept-Encoding" header
3773 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003774 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003775 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3776 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3777 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3778 "multipart"
3779 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3780 header
3781 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3782 and later
3783 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3784 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003785 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003786
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01003787 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003788
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003789 Examples :
3790 compression algo gzip
3791 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003792
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003793
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003794cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003795 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3796 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003797 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003798 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3799 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3800 yes | no | yes | yes
3801 Arguments :
3802 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3803 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3804 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3805 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3806 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3807 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003808 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003809 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3810 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3811
3812 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3813 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3814 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3815 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3816 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3817 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003818 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3819 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003820 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003821 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3822 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003823
3824 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003825 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003826
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003827 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003828 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003829 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003830 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003831 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3832 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3833 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3834 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3835 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3836 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3837 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003838
3839 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3840 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3841 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3842 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3843 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3844 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3845 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3846 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3847 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003848 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003849 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3850 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3851 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003852
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003853 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3854 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3855 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003856 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3857 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3858 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3859 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003860 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3861 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3862 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003863
3864 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3865 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3866 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3867 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3868 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3869 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3870 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3871 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3872 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3873
3874 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3875 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3876 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3877 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3878 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3879 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3880 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3881 persistence cookie in the cache.
3882 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3883
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003884 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3885 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3886 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3887 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3888 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003889 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003890 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3891 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3892 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3893 they logout.
3894
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003895 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3896 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3897 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3898 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3899
3900 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3901 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3902 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3903 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3904 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3905 this attribute.
3906
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003907 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003908 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003909 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3910 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3911 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3912 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3913 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3914 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003915
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003916 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3917 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3918 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3919 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3920 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3921 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3922 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3923 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003924 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003925 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3926 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3927 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3928 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3929 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3930 the site.
3931
3932 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3933 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3934 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3935 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3936 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3937 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3938 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3939 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3940 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3941 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3942 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3943 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3944 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003945 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003946 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3947 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3948
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003949 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3950 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3951 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3952 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3953 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3954 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3955
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003956 attr This option tells haproxy to add an extra attribute when a
3957 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
3958 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
3959 repeated.
3960
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003961 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3962 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3963 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3964 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003965
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003966 Examples :
3967 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3968 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3969 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003970 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003971
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003972 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003973
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003974
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003975declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3976 Declares a capture slot.
3977 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3978 no | yes | yes | no
3979 Arguments:
3980 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3981
3982 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3983 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3984 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3985 for use in the response.
3986
3987 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003988 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003989 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3990
3991
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003992default-server [param*]
3993 Change default options for a server in a backend
3994 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3995 yes | no | yes | yes
3996 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003997 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3998 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3999 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
4000 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004001
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004002 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004003 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
4004
4005 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004006
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004007
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004008default_backend <backend>
4009 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
4010 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4011 yes | yes | yes | no
4012 Arguments :
4013 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
4014
4015 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
4016 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
4017 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
4018 will catch all undetermined requests.
4019
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004020 Example :
4021
4022 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
4023 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
4024 default_backend dynamic
4025
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02004026 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004027
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004028
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02004029description <string>
4030 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
4031 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4032 no | yes | yes | yes
4033 Arguments : string
4034
4035 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
4036 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
4037 it describes.
4038 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
4039
4040
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004041disabled
4042 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4043 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4044 yes | yes | yes | yes
4045 Arguments : none
4046
4047 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
4048 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
4049 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
4050 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
4051 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
4052 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
4053 keyword in a "defaults" section.
4054
4055 See also : "enabled"
4056
4057
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004058dispatch <address>:<port>
4059 Set a default server address
4060 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4061 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004062 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004063
4064 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
4065 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4066 during start-up.
4067
4068 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
4069 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
4070 possible with normal servers.
4071
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02004072 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004073 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
4074 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
4075 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
4076 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
4077
4078 See also : "server"
4079
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004080
4081dynamic-cookie-key <string>
4082 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
4083 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4084 yes | no | yes | yes
4085 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
4086
4087 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004088 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004089 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
4090 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004091 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004092 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004093
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004094enabled
4095 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4096 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4097 yes | yes | yes | yes
4098 Arguments : none
4099
4100 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
4101 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
4102
4103 See also : "disabled"
4104
4105
4106errorfile <code> <file>
4107 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4108 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4109 yes | yes | yes | yes
4110 Arguments :
4111 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004112 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004113 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004114
4115 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004116 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004117 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004118 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
4119 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004120
4121 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4122 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4123 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4124
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004125 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4126
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02004127 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
4128 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
4129 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
4130 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
4131 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
4132 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
4133 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
4134 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
4135 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004136
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004137 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
4138 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
4139 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004140 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004141 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
4142
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004143 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004144
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004145 Example :
4146 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004147 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004148 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
4149 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
4150
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004151
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004152errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
4153 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
4154 section.
4155 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4156 yes | yes | yes | yes
4157 Arguments :
4158 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
4159
4160 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004161 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004162 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004163
4164 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
4165 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
4166 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
4167 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
4168 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004169 ones. Functionally, it is exactly the same as declaring all error files by
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004170 hand using "errorfile" directives.
4171
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004172 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
4173 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004174
4175 Example :
4176 errorfiles generic
4177 errorfiles site-1 403 404
4178
4179
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004180errorloc <code> <url>
4181errorloc302 <code> <url>
4182 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4183 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4184 yes | yes | yes | yes
4185 Arguments :
4186 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004187 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004188 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004189
4190 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4191 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4192 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4193 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004194 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004195
4196 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4197 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4198 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4199
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004200 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4201
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004202 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
4203 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
4204 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
4205 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004206 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004207 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
4208 request.
4209
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004210 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004211
4212
4213errorloc303 <code> <url>
4214 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4215 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4216 yes | yes | yes | yes
4217 Arguments :
4218 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004219 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004220 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004221
4222 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4223 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4224 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4225 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004226 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004227
4228 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4229 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4230 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4231
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004232 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4233
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004234 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
4235 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
4236 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
4237 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004238 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004239
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004240 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004241
4242
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004243email-alert from <emailaddr>
4244 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004245 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004246 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4247 yes | yes | yes | yes
4248
4249 Arguments :
4250
4251 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
4252
4253 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4254 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4255
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004256 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02004257 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
4258 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004259
4260
4261email-alert level <level>
4262 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
4263 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
4264 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4265 yes | yes | yes | yes
4266
4267 Arguments :
4268
4269 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
4270 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4271 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
4272
4273 By default level is alert
4274
4275 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4276 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4277 for the proxy.
4278
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09004279 Alerts are sent when :
4280
4281 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
4282 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
4283 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
4284 is notice or lower
4285 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
4286 and a health check status update occurs
4287
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004288 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
4289 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004290 section 3.6 about mailers.
4291
4292
4293email-alert mailers <mailersect>
4294 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
4295 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4296 yes | yes | yes | yes
4297
4298 Arguments :
4299
4300 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
4301
4302 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
4303 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4304
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004305 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
4306 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004307
4308
4309email-alert myhostname <hostname>
4310 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
4311 mailers.
4312 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4313 yes | yes | yes | yes
4314
4315 Arguments :
4316
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01004317 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004318
4319 By default the systems hostname is used.
4320
4321 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4322 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4323 for the proxy.
4324
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004325 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
4326 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004327
4328
4329email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004330 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004331 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
4332 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4333 yes | yes | yes | yes
4334
4335 Arguments :
4336
4337 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
4338
4339 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4340 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4341
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004342 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004343 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
4344
4345
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004346force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4347 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
4348 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004349 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004350
4351 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
4352 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
4353 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
4354 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
4355 marked down for maintenance operations.
4356
4357 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4358 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
4359 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
4360 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
4361 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
4362 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
4363 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
4364 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
4365 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
4366
4367 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4368 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
4369 is used.
4370
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004371 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02004372 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004373
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004374
4375filter <name> [param*]
4376 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
4377 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4378 no | yes | yes | yes
4379 Arguments :
4380 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
4381 referenced in section 9.
4382
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004383 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004384 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004385 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
4386 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004387
4388 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
4389 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
4390
4391 Example:
4392 listen
4393 bind *:80
4394
4395 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
4396 filter compression
4397 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
4398
4399 compression algo gzip
4400 compression offload
4401
4402 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4403
4404 See also : section 9.
4405
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004406
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004407fullconn <conns>
4408 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
4409 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4410 yes | no | yes | yes
4411 Arguments :
4412 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
4413 servers use the maximal number of connections.
4414
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004415 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004416 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004417 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004418 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
4419 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
4420 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
4421 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
4422 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004423 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004424
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004425 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
4426 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01004427 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
4428 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
4429 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004430
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004431 Example :
4432 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
4433 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
4434 # connections.
4435 backend dynamic
4436 fullconn 10000
4437 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4438 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4439
4440 See also : "maxconn", "server"
4441
4442
4443grace <time>
4444 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
4445 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01004446 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004447 Arguments :
4448 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
4449 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
4450 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
4451
4452 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
4453 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004454 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004455 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
4456
4457 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
4458 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
4459 simplify it.
4460
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004461
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004462hash-balance-factor <factor>
4463 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
4464 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4465 yes | no | no | yes
4466 Arguments :
4467 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
4468 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01004469 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004470
4471 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
4472 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
4473 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
4474 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
4475 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
4476 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
4477 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
4478
4479 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
4480 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
4481 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
4482 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
4483 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
4484
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004485 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
4486 consistent hashing mechanism.
4487
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004488 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
4489
4490
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004491hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004492 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
4493 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4494 yes | no | yes | yes
4495 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004496 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
4497 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004498
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004499 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
4500 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
4501 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
4502 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
4503 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
4504 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
4505 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
4506 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
4507 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
4508 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01004509
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004510 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
4511 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
4512 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
4513 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
4514 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
4515 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
4516 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
4517 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
4518 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
4519 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
4520 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
4521 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
4522 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004523 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
4524 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004525
4526 <function> is the hash function to be used :
4527
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004528 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004529 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
4530 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
4531 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004532 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
4533 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
4534 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004535
4536 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
4537 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004538 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
4539 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
4540 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
4541 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
4542
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01004543 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
4544 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
4545 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
4546 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
4547 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
4548 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
4549 parameter.
4550
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01004551 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
4552 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
4553 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
4554 used on strings.
4555
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004556 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
4557
4558 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
4559 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
4560 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
4561 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
4562 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
4563 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
4564 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
4565 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
4566 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
4567 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
4568 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
4569 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004570
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004571 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
4572 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
4573 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004574
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004575 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004576
4577
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004578http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4579 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
4580 ones).
4581
4582 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4583 no | yes | yes | yes
4584
4585 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
4586 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
4587 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4588 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4589 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4590 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4591
4592 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
4593 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
4594 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
4595
4596 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4597 below.
4598
4599 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
4600 instance.
4601
4602 Example:
4603 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
4604 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
4605 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
4606
4607http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4608
4609 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
4610 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
4611 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
4612 example, or to pass some internal information.
4613 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4614 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
4615 the resulting header from a previous rule.
4616
4617http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4618
4619 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
4620 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
4621
4622http-after-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4623
4624 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
4625
4626http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4627 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4628
4629 This works like "http-response replace-header".
4630
4631 Example:
4632 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
4633
4634 # applied to:
4635 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4636
4637 # outputs:
4638 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4639
4640 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
4641
4642http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4643 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4644
4645 This works like "http-response replace-value".
4646
4647 Example:
4648 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
4649
4650 # applied to:
4651 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
4652
4653 # outputs:
4654 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
4655
4656http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4657
4658 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
4659 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
4660 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
4661
4662http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
4663 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4664
4665 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
4666 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
4667 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
4668 fallback.
4669
4670 Example:
4671 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4672 http-response set-status 431
4673 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
4674 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
4675
4676http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4677
4678 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4679 inline.
4680
4681 Arguments:
4682 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4683 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4684 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4685 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4686 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4687 (request and response)
4688 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4689 processing
4690 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4691 processing
4692 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4693 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
4694 and '_'.
4695
4696 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4697 followed by some converters.
4698
4699 Example:
4700 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
4701
4702http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
4703
4704 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
4705 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
4706 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
4707 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
4708 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05004709 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004710 processing.
4711
4712 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
4713 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004714 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004715 rules evaluation.
4716
4717http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4718
4719 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
4720 details about <var-name>.
4721
4722 Example:
4723 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
4724
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004725
4726http-check comment <string>
4727 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
4728 it fails.
4729 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4730 yes | no | yes | yes
4731
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004732 Arguments :
4733 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
4734 rule fails.
4735
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004736 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
4737 user-friendly error reporting.
4738
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004739 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check send" and
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004740 "http-check expect".
4741
4742
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004743http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
4744 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02004745 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004746 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
4747 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4748 yes | no | yes | yes
4749
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004750 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004751 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
4752
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004753 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004754 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004755
4756 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
4757 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
4758 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
4759 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
4760
4761 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
4762
4763 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
4764
4765 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
4766
4767 ssl opens a ciphered connection
4768
4769 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
4770
4771 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
4772 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
4773 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
4774 is used.
4775
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02004776 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
4777 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
4778 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
4779 haproxy -vv.
4780
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004781 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
4782
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004783 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
4784 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
4785 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
4786 different ports or with different servers.
4787
4788 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
4789 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
4790 the port with a "http-check connect".
4791
4792 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
4793 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
4794 do.
4795
4796 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
4797 unset-var or comment rules.
4798
4799 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004800 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
4801 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
4802 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
4803 option httpchk
4804
4805 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02004806 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02004807 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004808 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02004809 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02004810 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004811
4812 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
4813
4814 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004815
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004816
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004817http-check disable-on-404
4818 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
4819 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004820 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004821 Arguments : none
4822
4823 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
4824 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
4825 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
4826 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
4827 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
4828 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
4829 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
4830 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004831 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
4832 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
4833 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
4834
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004835 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004836
4837
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004838http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004839 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
4840 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
4841 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004842 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004843 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02004844 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004845
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004846 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004847 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
4848
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004849 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
4850 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
4851 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
4852 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
4853 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
4854 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
4855 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
4856 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
4857 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
4858 result is always conclusive.
4859
4860 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
4861 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
4862 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02004863 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
4864 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
4865 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, for
4866 example 404 with disable-on-404
4867 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
4868 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
4869 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004870
4871 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
4872 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02004873 "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are supported :
4874 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
4875 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
4876 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
4877 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
4878 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004879
4880 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
4881 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02004882 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
4883 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
4884 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
4885 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004886 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
4887
4888 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
4889 informational message reported in logs if the expect
4890 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
4891 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
4892
4893 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
4894 informational message reported in logs if an error
4895 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
4896 log-format string.
4897
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004898 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02004899 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
4900 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004901 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
4902 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
4903 details on the supported keywords.
4904
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02004905 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
4906 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
4907 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
4908 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004909
4910 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
4911 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
4912 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
4913 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
4914 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
4915
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02004916 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
4917 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
4918 codes. A health check response will be considered as
4919 valid if the response's status code matches any status
4920 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
4921 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4922 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004923
4924 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004925 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004926 response's status code matches the expression. If the
4927 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4928 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4929 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
4930
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02004931 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
4932 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02004933 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
4934 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
4935 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
4936 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
4937 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
4938 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
4939 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
4940 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02004941 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
4942 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
4943 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
4944 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
4945 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
4946 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
4947 insensitive on the header names.
4948
4949 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
4950 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
4951 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
4952 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
4953 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
4954 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02004955
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004956 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004957 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004958 response's body contains this exact string. If the
4959 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4960 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
4961 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
4962 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004963 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004964 trace).
4965
4966 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004967 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004968 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
4969 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4970 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
4971 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
4972 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004973 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004974
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02004975 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
4976 A health check response will be considered valid if the
4977 response's body contains the string resulting of the
4978 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
4979 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4980 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
4981
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004982 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
4983 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
4984 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
4985 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
4986 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
4987 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
4988 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
4989 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
4990
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004991 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
4992 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
4993 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
4994 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
4995 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01004996
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004997 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
4998 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
4999
5000 Examples :
5001 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005002 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005003
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005004 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
5005 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
5006
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005007 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005008 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005009
5010 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005011 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005012
5013 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005014 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005015
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005016 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005017 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005018
5019
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005020http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005021 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
5022 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005023 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
5024 health checks.
5025 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5026 yes | no | yes | yes
5027 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005028 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5029
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005030 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
5031 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
5032 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
5033 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
5034 to invent non-standard ones.
5035
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005036 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5037 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
5038 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
5039 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5040
5041 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5042 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
5043 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5044 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005045
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02005046 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005047 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005048 1.0, so turning it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005049 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
5050 to add it.
5051
5052 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
5053 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
5054 to the log-format rules.
5055
5056 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
5057 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
5058 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005059
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005060 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
5061 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
5062 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
5063 request.
5064
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005065 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
5066 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
5067 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005068 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
5069 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
5070 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
5071 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005072 deprecated. Note also the "Connection: close" header is still added if a
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005073 "http-check expect" directive is defined independently of this directive, just
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005074 like the state header if the directive "http-check send-state" is defined.
5075
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005076 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
5077 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005078 header should not be present in the request provided by "http-check send". If
5079 so, it will be ignored.
5080
5081 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
5082 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
5083 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
5084 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
5085 configured request authority.
5086
5087 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
5088 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005089
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005090 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005091
5092
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005093http-check send-state
5094 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
5095 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5096 yes | no | yes | yes
5097 Arguments : none
5098
5099 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
5100 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
5101 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
5102 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
5103 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
5104
5105 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
5106 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
5107 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
5108 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
5109 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08005110 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
5111 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
5112 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5113
5114 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
5115 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
5116 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5117
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005118 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
5119 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
5120 checked in multiple backends.
5121
5122 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
5123 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
5124
5125 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
5126 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
5127 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
5128 one fails.
5129
5130 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
5131 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
5132 connections on all servers of the same backend.
5133
5134 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
5135 server's queue.
5136
5137 Example of a header received by the application server :
5138 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
5139 scur=13/22; qcur=0
5140
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005141 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
5142 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005143
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005144
5145http-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005146 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005147 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5148 yes | no | yes | yes
5149
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005150 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005151 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5152 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5153 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5154 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5155 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5156 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5157 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5158 and '-'.
5159
5160 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
5161
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005162 Examples :
5163 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005164
5165
5166http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005167 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005168 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5169 yes | no | yes | yes
5170
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005171 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005172 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5173 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5174 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5175 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5176 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5177 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5178 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5179 and '-'.
5180
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005181 Examples :
5182 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005183
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005184
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005185http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
5186 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5187 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5188 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5189 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
5190 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5191 yes | yes | yes | yes
5192 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005193 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005194 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005195 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
5196 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005197
5198 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
5199 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
5200 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
5201 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
5202
5203 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
5204 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
5205 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
5206 a frontend, the default error message is used.
5207
5208 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
5209 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
5210 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
5211 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
5212 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
5213 chroot is performed.
5214
5215 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
5216 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
5217 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
5218 considered.
5219
5220 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5221 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5222 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5223 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5224 considered as a raw string.
5225
5226 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
5227 The content-type must always be set as argument to
5228 "content-type".
5229
5230 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5231 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5232 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5233 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5234 evaluated as a log-format string.
5235
5236 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
5237 payload. The content-type must always be set as
5238 argument to "content-type".
5239
5240 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
5241 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
5242 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
5243 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
5244
5245 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
5246 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
5247 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
5248 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
5249 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
5250 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
5251 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
5252 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
5253
5254 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5255 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5256 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
5257
5258 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
5259 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
5260
5261
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005262http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005263 Access control for Layer 7 requests
5264
5265 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5266 no | yes | yes | yes
5267
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005268 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5269 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5270 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5271 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5272 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005273
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005274 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5275 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005276
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005277 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005278
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005279 Example:
5280 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
5281 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
5282 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005283
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005284 http-request allow if nagios
5285 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
5286 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
5287 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01005288
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005289 Example:
5290 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
5291 acl add path /addacl
5292 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005293
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005294 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005295
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005296 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
5297 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005298
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005299 Example:
5300 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
5301 acl setmap path /setmap
5302 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005303
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005304 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005305
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005306 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
5307 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005308
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005309 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5310 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005311
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005312http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005313
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005314 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5315 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5316 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5317 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5318 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
5319 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5320 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5321 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005322
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005323http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005324
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005325 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
5326 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
5327 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
5328 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
5329 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
5330 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
5331 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
5332 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005333
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005334http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005335
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005336 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
5337 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005338
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005339
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005340http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005341
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005342 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
5343 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
5344 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
5345 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
5346 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005347
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005348 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
5349 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
5350 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
5351 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
5352 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
5353 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
5354 instead.
5355
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005356 Example:
5357 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
5358 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005359
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005360http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005361
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005362 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005363
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005364http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
5365 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005366
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005367 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
5368 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
5369 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
5370 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
5371 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
5372 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
5373 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
5374 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
5375 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005376
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005377 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
5378 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
5379 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01005380 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
5381
5382 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
5383 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
5384 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
5385 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005386
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005387http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005388
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005389 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5390 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5391 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5392 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5393 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5394 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005395
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005396http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02005397
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005398 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02005399
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005400http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02005401
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005402 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5403 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5404 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5405 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5406 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
5407 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02005408
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005409http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5410http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
5411 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5412 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5413 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5414 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04005415
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005416 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
5417 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
5418 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005419 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005420 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
5421 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
5422 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005423 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005424 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04005425
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02005426http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5427 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
5428 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
5429 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
5430
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01005431http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
5432
5433 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
5434 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
5435 pointed by <resolvers>.
5436 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
5437 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
5438 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
5439 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
5440 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
5441 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
5442 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
5443 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
5444 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
5445 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
5446 to 0.0.0.0.
5447
5448 Example:
5449 resolvers mydns
5450 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
5451 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
5452 timeout retry 1s
5453 hold valid 10s
5454 hold nx 3s
5455 hold other 3s
5456 hold obsolete 0s
5457 accepted_payload_size 8192
5458
5459 frontend fe
5460 bind 10.42.0.1:80
5461 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
5462 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
5463
5464 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
5465 # which mean DNS resolution error
5466 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
5467
5468 default_backend be
5469
5470 backend b_503
5471 # dummy backend used to return 503.
5472 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
5473 # 503 error page to end users
5474
5475 backend be
5476 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
5477 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
5478 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
5479 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
5480 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
5481
5482 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
5483 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
5484
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01005485http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5486
5487 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
5488 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
5489 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
5490 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01005491 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
5492 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01005493
5494 See RFC 8297 for more information.
5495
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005496http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005497
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005498 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
5499 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
5500 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
5501 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
5502 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005503
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005504http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005505
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005506 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
5507 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
5508 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
5509 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005510
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005511http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5512 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02005513
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005514 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005515 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
5516 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
5517 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
5518 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
5519 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02005520
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005521 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
5522 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
5523 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
5524 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
5525 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01005526
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005527 Example:
5528 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
5529
5530 # applied to:
5531 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
5532
5533 # outputs:
5534 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
5535
5536 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005537
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005538 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
5539
5540 # applied to:
5541 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005542
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005543 # outputs:
5544 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005545
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005546http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5547 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5548
5549 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
5550 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
5551 after an optional scheme+authority. It does contain the query string if any
5552 is present. The replacement does not modify the scheme nor authority.
5553
5554 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
5555 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
5556 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
5557
5558 Example:
5559 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
5560 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
5561
5562 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
5563 http-request replace-path ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
5564
5565 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
5566 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
5567 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
5568 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
5569
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005570http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5571 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5572
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005573 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
5574 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
5575 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
5576 against.
5577
5578 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
5579 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
5580 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005581
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005582 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
5583 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
5584 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
5585 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
5586 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
5587 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
5588 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
5589 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
5590 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005591 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
5592 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005593
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005594 Example:
5595 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
5596 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005597
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005598 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
5599 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005600
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005601http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5602 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005603
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005604 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
5605 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
5606 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
5607 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005608
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005609 Example:
5610 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02005611
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005612 # applied to:
5613 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02005614
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005615 # outputs:
5616 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01005617
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005618http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
5619 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5620 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005621 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005622 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5623
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005624 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005625 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
5626 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005627 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005628 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005629 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005630 are followed to create the response :
5631
5632 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
5633 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
5634 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
5635 ignored.
5636
5637 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
5638 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005639 status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005640 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any,
5641 is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005642
5643 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
5644 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
5645 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005646 by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005647 and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005648
5649 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
5650 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
5651 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005652 must be one of the status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005653 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
5654 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005655
5656 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
5657 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
5658 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
5659 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
5660 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
5661 as a raw content.
5662
5663 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
5664 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
5665 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
5666 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
5667 considered as a raw string.
5668
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005669 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
5670 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
5671 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
5672 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
5673
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005674 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
5675 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005676 reserved to the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005677
5678 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
5679
5680 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005681 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005682 if { path /ping }
5683
5684 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
5685 if { path /favicon.ico }
5686
5687 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
5688 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
5689 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
5690
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005691http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5692http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005693
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005694 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
5695 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
5696 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005697
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005698http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
5699 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005700
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005701 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
5702 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
5703 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
5704 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005705
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005706http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005707
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005708 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
5709 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
5710 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
5711 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
5712 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005713
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005714 Arguments:
5715 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5716 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005717
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005718 Example:
5719 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
5720 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005721
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005722 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
5723 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005724
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005725http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005726
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005727 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
5728 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
5729 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005730
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005731 Arguments:
5732 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5733 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005734
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005735 Example:
5736 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
5737 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005738
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005739 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
5740 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
5741 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005742
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005743http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005744
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005745 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
5746 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
5747 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
5748 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
5749 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005750
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005751 Example:
5752 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
5753 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
5754 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
5755 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
5756 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
5757 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
5758 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
5759 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
5760 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005761
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005762http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005763
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005764 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
5765 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
5766 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
5767 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
5768 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005769
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005770http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
5771 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005772
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005773 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5774 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5775 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
5776 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
5777 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
5778 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
5779 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
5780 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
5781 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005782
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005783http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005784
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005785 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
5786 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
5787 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
5788 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
5789 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
5790 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
5791 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02005792
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005793http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005794
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005795 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
5796 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
5797 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005798
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005799http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005800
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005801 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
5802 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
5803 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
5804 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
5805 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
5806 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
5807 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
5808 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005809
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005810http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02005811
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005812 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
5813 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
5814 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
5815 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
5816 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
5817 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02005818
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005819 Example :
5820 # prepend the host name before the path
5821 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005822
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005823http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02005824
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005825 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
5826 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
5827 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
5828 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
5829 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005830
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005831http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005832
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005833 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
5834 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
5835 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
5836 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
5837 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
5838 values have higher priority.
5839 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
5840 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
5841 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
5842 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
5843 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005844
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005845http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005846
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005847 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
5848 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
5849 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
5850 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
5851 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
5852 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
5853 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08005854
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005855 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005856
5857 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005858 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
5859 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005860
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005861http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5862 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
5863 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
5864 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005865 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
5866 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005867
5868 Arguments :
5869 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5870 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005871
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005872 See also "option forwardfor".
5873
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01005874 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005875 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
5876 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
5877
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005878 # After the masking this will track connections
5879 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
5880 http-request track-sc0 src
5881
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005882 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
5883 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
5884
5885http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5886
5887 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
5888 expression.
5889
5890 Arguments:
5891 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5892 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005893
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005894 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005895 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
5896 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
5897
5898 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
5899 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
5900 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
5901
5902http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5903
5904 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5905 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
5906 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
5907 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
5908 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
5909 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
5910 information from the request.
5911
5912 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
5913
5914http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5915
5916 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
5917 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
5918 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
5919 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
5920 path and the query string.
5921 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
5922
5923http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5924
5925 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5926 inline.
5927
5928 Arguments:
5929 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5930 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5931 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5932 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5933 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5934 (request and response)
5935 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5936 processing
5937 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5938 processing
5939 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5940 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
5941 and '_'.
5942
5943 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5944 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005945
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005946 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005947 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005948
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005949http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
5950 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005951
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005952 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
5953 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
5954 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
5955 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
5956 agent name must be used.
5957
5958 Arguments:
5959 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
5960
5961 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
5962 configuration.
5963
5964http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5965
5966 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
5967 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
5968 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
5969 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
5970 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
5971 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
5972 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
5973 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
5974 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
5975 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
5976 action.
5977 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
5978 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
5979 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
5980 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
5981 you fully understand how it works.
5982
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005983http-request strict-mode { on | off }
5984
5985 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5986 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5987 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5988 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5989 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005990 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005991 processing.
5992
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01005993 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005994 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
5995 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
5996 rules evaluation.
5997
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005998http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5999http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6000 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6001 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6002 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6003 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006004
6005 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
6006 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
6007 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006008 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
6009 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
6010 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
6011 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
6012 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
6013 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
6014 things worse by forcing haproxy and the front firewall to support insane
6015 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
6016 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
6017 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006018 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006019 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6020 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6021 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
6022 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6023 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006024
6025http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6026http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6027http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6028
6029 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
6030 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
6031 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
6032 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
6033 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first
6034 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6035 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
6036 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
6037 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6038 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
6039 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
6040 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
6041
6042 Arguments :
6043 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
6044 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
6045 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
6046 select which table entry to update the counters.
6047
6048 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
6049 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
6050 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
6051 that table until the session ends.
6052
6053 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
6054 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
6055 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
6056 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
6057 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
6058 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
6059 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
6060 useful information.
6061
6062 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
6063 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
6064 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
6065 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
6066 checks that make use of it.
6067
6068http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6069
6070 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006071
6072 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006073 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006074
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01006075http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6076
6077 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
6078 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
6079 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
6080 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
6081 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
6082 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6083
6084 Arguments :
6085 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
6086
6087 Example:
6088 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
6089
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006090http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006091
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006092 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
6093 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
6094 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006095
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006096
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006097http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006098 Access control for Layer 7 responses
6099
6100 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6101 no | yes | yes | yes
6102
6103 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
6104 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
6105 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
6106 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
6107 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
6108 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
6109
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006110 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
6111 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006112
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006113 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006114
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006115 Example:
6116 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02006117
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006118 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006119
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006120 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
6121 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006122
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006123 Example:
6124 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006125
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006126 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006127
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006128 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
6129 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006130
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006131 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6132 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006133
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006134http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006135
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006136 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6137 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6138 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6139 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
6140 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
6141 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6142 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6143 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006144
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006145http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006146
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006147 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
6148 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
6149 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
6150 example, or to pass some internal information.
6151 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
6152 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
6153 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006154
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006155http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006156
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006157 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
6158 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006159
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02006160http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006161
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006162 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006163
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006164http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006165
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006166 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
6167 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
6168 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
6169 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
6170 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
6171 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
6172 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006173
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006174 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
6175 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
6176 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
6177 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
6178 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01006179
6180 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
6181 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
6182 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
6183 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006184
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006185http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006186
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006187 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6188 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6189 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6190 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6191 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6192 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02006193
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006194http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02006195
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006196 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02006197
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006198http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02006199
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006200 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6201 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6202 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6203 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6204 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
6205 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006206
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006207http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6208http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6209 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6210 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6211 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6212 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006213
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006214 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
6215 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
6216 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006217 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006218 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
6219 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
6220 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01006221 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006222 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006223
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006224http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006225
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006226 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
6227 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
6228 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
6229 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
6230 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
6231 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02006232
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006233http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6234 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02006235
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006236 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
6237 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01006238
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006239 Example:
6240 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02006241
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006242 # applied to:
6243 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006244
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006245 # outputs:
6246 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006247
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006248 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006249
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006250http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6251 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006252
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01006253 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006254 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006255
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006256 Example:
6257 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006258
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006259 # applied to:
6260 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006261
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006262 # outputs:
6263 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006264
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006265http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
6266 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6267 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006268 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006269 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6270
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006271 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006272 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6273 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006274 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006275 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006276 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006277 are followed to create the response :
6278
6279 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6280 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
6281 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6282 ignored.
6283
6284 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
6285 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006286 status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006287 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any,
6288 is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006289
6290 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6291 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6292 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006293 by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006294 and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006295
6296 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6297 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6298 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006299 must be one of the status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006300 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
6301 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006302
6303 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6304 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6305 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6306 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6307 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6308 as a raw content.
6309
6310 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6311 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6312 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6313 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6314 considered as a raw string.
6315
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006316 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
6317 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6318 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6319 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6320
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006321 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6322 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006323 reserved to the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006324
6325 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
6326
6327 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006328 http-response return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006329 if { status eq 404 }
6330
6331 http-response return content-type text/plain \
6332 string "This is the end !" \
6333 if { status eq 500 }
6334
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006335http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6336http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08006337
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006338 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6339 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6340 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02006341
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006342http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6343 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02006344
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006345 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6346 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6347 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6348 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01006349
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006350http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006351
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006352 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6353 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6354 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6355 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6356 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006357
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006358 Arguments:
6359 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006360
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006361 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6362 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006363
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006364http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006365
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006366 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
6367 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
6368 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006369
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006370http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6371
6372 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6373 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6374 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6375 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
6376 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
6377
6378http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6379
6380 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6381 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6382 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6383 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6384 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
6385 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
6386 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6387 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
6388 be triggered by an HTTP response.
6389
6390http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6391
6392 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
6393 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6394 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
6395 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
6396 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
6397 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
6398 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
6399
6400http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6401
6402 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
6403 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
6404 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
6405 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
6406 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
6407 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6408 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6409 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
6410
6411http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
6412 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6413
6414 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
6415 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
6416 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
6417 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006418
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006419 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006420 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
6421 http-response set-status 431
6422 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
6423 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006424
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006425http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006426
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006427 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6428 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
6429 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
6430 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
6431 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
6432 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
6433 based on some information from the request.
6434
6435 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6436
6437http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6438
6439 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6440 inline.
6441
6442 Arguments:
6443 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6444 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6445 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6446 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6447 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6448 (request and response)
6449 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6450 processing
6451 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6452 processing
6453 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6454 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
6455 and '_'.
6456
6457 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6458 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006459
6460 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006461 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006462
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006463http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006464
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006465 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6466 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6467 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6468 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6469 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6470 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6471 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6472 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6473 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6474 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6475 action.
6476 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6477 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6478 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6479 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6480 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006481
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006482http-response strict-mode { on | off }
6483
6484 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6485 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6486 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6487 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6488 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006489 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006490 processing.
6491
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006492 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006493 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006494 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006495 rules evaluation.
6496
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006497http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6498http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6499http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006500
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006501 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
6502 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
6503 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
6504 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
6505 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
6506 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
6507
6508http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6509
6510 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
6511 about <var-name>.
6512
6513 Example:
6514 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
6515
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02006516
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006517http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
6518 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
6519
6520 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6521 yes | no | yes | yes
6522
6523 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006524 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
6525 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
6526 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006527
6528 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
6529
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006530 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
6531 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
6532 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
6533 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
6534 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
6535 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
6536 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
6537 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
6538 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
6539 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006540
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006541 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
6542 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
6543 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
6544 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
6545 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
6546 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
6547 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
6548 effects.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006549
6550 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
6551 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
6552 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
6553 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
6554 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
6555 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
6556 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
6557 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02006558 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006559 downsides of rare connection failures.
6560
6561 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
6562 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
6563 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
6564 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
6565 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
6566 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006567 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006568 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
6569 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
6570 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
6571 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
6572 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
6573
6574 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006575 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
6576 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
6577 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006578
6579 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006580 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006581
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02006582 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
6583 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006584
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01006585 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006586
6587 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
6588 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
6589 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
6590
6591 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
6592
6593
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006594http-send-name-header [<header>]
6595 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006596 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6597 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006598 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006599 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
6600
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02006601 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
6602 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
6603 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
6604 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
6605 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
6606 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
6607 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
6608 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
6609 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
6610 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
6611 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
6612 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
6613 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
6614 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
6615 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
6616 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006617
6618 See also : "server"
6619
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01006620id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02006621 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
6622 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6623 no | yes | yes | yes
6624 Arguments : none
6625
6626 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
6627 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
6628 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01006629
6630
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006631ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
6632 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
6633 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01006634 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006635
6636 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
6637 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
6638 and running).
6639
6640 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
6641 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
6642 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006643 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006644 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
6645
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006646 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
6647 "unless" condition is met.
6648
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03006649 Example:
6650 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
6651 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
6652 ignore-persist if url_static
6653
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006654 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
6655
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006656load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
6657 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
6658 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6659 yes | no | yes | yes
6660
6661 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
6662 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
6663 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006664 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006665 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
6666 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
6667 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
6668 over the stats socket and redirect output.
6669
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006670 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006671 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02006672 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006673
6674 Arguments:
6675 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
6676 named "server-state-file".
6677
6678 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
6679 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
6680 name is used as a file name.
6681
6682 none don't load any stat for this backend
6683
6684 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01006685 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
6686 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
6687 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006688 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01006689 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006690
6691 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
6692 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
6693
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006694 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006695
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006696 global
6697 stats socket /tmp/socket
6698 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006699
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006700 defaults
6701 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006702
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006703 backend bk
6704 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
6705 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006706
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006707
6708 Then one can run :
6709
6710 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
6711
6712 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
6713
6714 1
6715 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
6716 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6717 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6718
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006719 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006720
6721 global
6722 stats socket /tmp/socket
6723 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
6724
6725 defaults
6726 load-server-state-from-file local
6727
6728 backend bk
6729 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
6730 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
6731
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006732
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006733 Then one can run :
6734
6735 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
6736
6737 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
6738
6739 1
6740 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
6741 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6742 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6743
6744 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
6745 "show servers state"
6746
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006747
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006748log global
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02006749log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
6750 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006751no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006752 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
6753 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6754 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006755
6756 Prefix :
6757 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
6758 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
6759 prefix does not allow arguments.
6760
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006761 Arguments :
6762 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
6763 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
6764 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
6765 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
6766 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
6767 parameter.
6768
6769 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
6770 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
6771
6772 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
6773 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
6774 standard syslog port).
6775
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01006776 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
6777 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
6778 standard syslog port).
6779
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006780 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
6781 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
6782 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006783 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006784
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006785 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
6786 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
6787 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
6788 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
6789 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
6790 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
6791 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
6792 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
6793 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
6794 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
6795 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
6796 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
6797 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
6798 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
6799 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
6800 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006801 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
6802 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006803
6804 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
6805 and "fd@2", see above.
6806
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02006807 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
6808 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
6809 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
6810 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
6811 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
6812 having the logs instantly available.
6813
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006814 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
6815 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006816
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02006817 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
6818 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
6819 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
6820 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
6821 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
6822 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
6823 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
6824 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
6825 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
6826 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006827 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02006828
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02006829 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
6830 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
6831 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
6832 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
6833 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
6834
6835 <sample_size>
6836 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
6837 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
6838 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
6839 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
6840 (see also <ranges> parameter).
6841
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01006842 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
6843 one of the following :
6844
6845 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
6846 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
6847
6848 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
6849 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
6850
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02006851 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
6852 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
6853 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
6854 designed to be used with a local log server.
6855
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01006856 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
6857 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
6858 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
6859 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
6860 systemd logger consumes.
6861
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02006862 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
6863 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
6864 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
6865 used with a local log server.
6866
6867 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
6868 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
6869 designed to be used with a local log server.
6870
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006871 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
6872 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
6873 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
6874 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
6875
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006876 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
6877
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01006878 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
6879 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
6880 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
6881
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006882 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
6883 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
6884 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
6885 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006886
6887 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
6888 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
6889 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02006890 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
6891 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
6892 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
6893 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
6894 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006895
6896 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
6897
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006898 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
6899 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
6900 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006901
6902 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
6903 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
6904 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
6905 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
6906
6907 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
6908 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006909
6910 Example :
6911 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006912 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
6913 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
6914 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02006915 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
6916 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02006917 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006918
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006919
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006920log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01006921 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
6922 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6923 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006924
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01006925 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
6926 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
6927 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
6928 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
6929 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006930
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006931 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
6932 "option httplog" directives.
6933
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02006934log-format-sd <string>
6935 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
6936 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6937 yes | yes | yes | no
6938
6939 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
6940 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
6941 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
6942 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
6943 which covers the log format string in depth.
6944
6945 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
6946 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
6947
6948 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
6949 log format to "rfc5424".
6950
6951 Example :
6952 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
6953
6954
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01006955log-tag <string>
6956 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
6957 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6958 yes | yes | yes | yes
6959
6960 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
6961 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
6962 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
6963 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
6964 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
6965 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
6966 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
6967 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
6968 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006969
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02006970max-keep-alive-queue <value>
6971 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
6972 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6973 yes | no | yes | yes
6974
6975 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
6976 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
6977 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
6978 servers.
6979
6980 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
6981 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
6982 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
6983 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
6984 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006985 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02006986 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
6987 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
6988 picking a different server.
6989
6990 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
6991 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
6992 even if they have to be queued.
6993
6994 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
6995 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
6996
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01006997max-session-srv-conns <nb>
6998 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
6999 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
7000 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007001
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007002maxconn <conns>
7003 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
7004 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7005 yes | yes | yes | no
7006 Arguments :
7007 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
7008 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
7009 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
7010 closes.
7011
7012 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
7013 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
7014 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
7015 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01007016 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
7017 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
7018 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
7019 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007020
7021 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
7022 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
7023 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
7024
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01007025 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
7026 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02007027
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007028 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
7029
7030
7031mode { tcp|http|health }
7032 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
7033 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7034 yes | yes | yes | yes
7035 Arguments :
7036 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
7037 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
7038 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
7039 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
7040
7041 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
7042 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
7043 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
7044 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
7045 brings HAProxy most of its value.
7046
7047 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02007048 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
7049 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
7050 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
7051 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
7052 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
7053 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
7054 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007055
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007056 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
7057 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
7058 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007059
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007060 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007061 defaults http_instances
7062 mode http
7063
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007064 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007065
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007066
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007067monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007068 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007069 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7070 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007071 Arguments :
7072 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
7073 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007074 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007075 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
7076 backend and its backup.
7077
7078 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
7079 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
7080 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
7081 servers in a list of backends.
7082
7083 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
7084 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
7085 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
7086 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
7087 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
7088 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
7089 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02007090 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
7091 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007092
7093 Example:
7094 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007095 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007096 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
7097 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
7098 monitor-uri /site_alive
7099 monitor fail if site_dead
7100
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02007101 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007102
7103
7104monitor-net <source>
7105 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
7106 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7107 yes | yes | yes | no
7108 Arguments :
7109 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
7110 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
7111 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
7112 followed by a mask.
7113
7114 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
7115 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007116 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007117 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
7118
7119 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
7120 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
7121 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
7122 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02007123 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
7124 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
7125 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007126
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02007127 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
7128 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
7129 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
7130 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
7131 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
7132 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007133
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01007134 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
7135 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007136
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007137 Example :
7138 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
7139 frontend www
7140 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
7141
7142 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
7143
7144
7145monitor-uri <uri>
7146 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
7147 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7148 yes | yes | yes | no
7149 Arguments :
7150 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
7151 health status instead of forwarding the request.
7152
7153 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
7154 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
7155 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
7156 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
7157 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
7158 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
7159 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
7160 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
7161
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01007162 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007163 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
7164 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
7165 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
7166 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
7167 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
7168 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007169
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01007170 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
7171 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
7172 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
7173 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
7174
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007175 Example :
7176 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
7177 frontend www
7178 mode http
7179 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
7180
7181 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
7182
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007183
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007184option abortonclose
7185no option abortonclose
7186 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
7187 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7188 yes | no | yes | yes
7189 Arguments : none
7190
7191 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
7192 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
7193 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
7194 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007195 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007196 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
7197 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
7198 encountered while delivering the response.
7199
7200 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
7201 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
7202 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
7203 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
7204 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
7205 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007206 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007207 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007208 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007209 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
7210 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
7211 still not served and not pollute the servers.
7212
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007213 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
7214 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007215 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
7216 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
7217 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
7218 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
7219 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
7220 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007221 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007222
7223 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7224 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7225
7226 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
7227
7228
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007229option accept-invalid-http-request
7230no option accept-invalid-http-request
7231 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
7232 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7233 yes | yes | yes | no
7234 Arguments : none
7235
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007236 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007237 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007238 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007239 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
7240 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
7241 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
7242 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
7243 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01007244 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
7245 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
7246 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
7247 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007248 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007249 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02007250 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
7251 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
7252 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007253
7254 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
7255 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
7256 been confirmed.
7257
7258 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
7259 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01007260 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
7261 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007262 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
7263
7264 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7265 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7266
7267 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
7268 stats socket.
7269
7270
7271option accept-invalid-http-response
7272no option accept-invalid-http-response
7273 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
7274 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7275 yes | no | yes | yes
7276 Arguments : none
7277
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007278 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007279 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007280 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007281 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
7282 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
7283 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
7284 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
7285 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007286 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
7287 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
7288 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007289
7290 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
7291 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
7292 been confirmed.
7293
7294 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
7295 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
7296 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
7297 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
7298
7299 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7300 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7301
7302 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
7303 stats socket.
7304
7305
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007306option allbackups
7307no option allbackups
7308 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
7309 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7310 yes | no | yes | yes
7311 Arguments : none
7312
7313 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
7314 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
7315 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
7316 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
7317 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
7318 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
7319 order between the backup servers anymore.
7320
7321 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
7322 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
7323
7324 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7325 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7326
7327
7328option checkcache
7329no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08007330 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007331 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7332 yes | no | yes | yes
7333 Arguments : none
7334
7335 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
7336 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007337 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007338 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
7339 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007340 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007341
7342 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007343 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007344 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007345 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
7346 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007347 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007348 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01007349 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
7350 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007351 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01007352 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
7353 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007354 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007355 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
7356 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
7357 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
7358 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
7359 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
7360 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
7361 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
7362 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
7363 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
7364
7365 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007366 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
7367 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
7368 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
7369 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007370
7371 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
7372 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007373 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007374 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007375
7376 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7377 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7378
7379
7380option clitcpka
7381no option clitcpka
7382 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
7383 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7384 yes | yes | yes | no
7385 Arguments : none
7386
7387 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7388 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007389 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007390 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7391
7392 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7393 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7394 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7395 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7396
7397 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7398 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7399 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7400 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7401 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7402
7403 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7404
7405 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7406 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7407 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
7408
7409 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7410 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7411
7412 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
7413
7414
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007415option contstats
7416 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
7417 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7418 yes | yes | yes | no
7419 Arguments : none
7420
7421 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
7422 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
7423 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
7424 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01007425 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
7426 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
7427 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
7428 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
7429 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007430
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02007431option disable-h2-upgrade
7432no option disable-h2-upgrade
7433 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
7434 connection.
7435 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7436 yes | yes | yes | no
7437 Arguments : none
7438
7439 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
7440 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
7441 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
7442 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
7443 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be used to
7444 disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only supported
7445 for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to force the
7446 HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind line.
7447
7448 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7449 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007450
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007451option dontlog-normal
7452no option dontlog-normal
7453 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
7454 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7455 yes | yes | yes | no
7456 Arguments : none
7457
7458 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
7459 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
7460 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
7461 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
7462 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
7463 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
7464 logged.
7465
7466 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
7467 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
7468 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
7469
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007470 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007471 logging.
7472
7473
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007474option dontlognull
7475no option dontlognull
7476 Enable or disable logging of null connections
7477 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7478 yes | yes | yes | no
7479 Arguments : none
7480
7481 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
7482 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
7483 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
7484 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
7485 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
7486 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007487 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
7488 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
7489 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007490
7491 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007492 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007493 would not be logged.
7494
7495 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7496 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7497
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007498 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
7499 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007500
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007501
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007502option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007503 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
7504 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7505 yes | yes | yes | yes
7506 Arguments :
7507 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
7508 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007509 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007510 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007511
7512 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
7513 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
7514 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
7515 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
7516 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
7517 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
7518 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007519 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
7520 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
7521 possible that the client has already brought one.
7522
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007523 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007524 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007525 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007526 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007527 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007528 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007529
7530 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
7531 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
7532 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
7533 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
7534 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
7535 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
7536 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
7537
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007538 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
7539 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
7540 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
7541 are under the control of the end-user.
7542
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007543 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007544 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
7545 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007546 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
7547 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
7548 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007549
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007550 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007551 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
7552 frontend www
7553 mode http
7554 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
7555
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007556 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
7557 backend www
7558 mode http
7559 option forwardfor header X-Client
7560
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007561 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007562 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007563
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007564
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02007565option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
7566no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
7567 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
7568 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7569 yes | yes | yes | no
7570 Arguments : none
7571
7572 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
7573 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
7574 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
7575 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
7576 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
7577 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
7578 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
7579
7580 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
7581 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
7582 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
7583 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
7584 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
7585 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
7586 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
7587 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
7588 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
7589 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
7590
7591 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
7592
7593 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7594 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7595
7596 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
7597 "h1-case-adjust-file".
7598
7599
7600option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
7601no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
7602 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
7603 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7604 yes | no | yes | yes
7605 Arguments : none
7606
7607 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
7608 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
7609 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
7610 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
7611 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
7612 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
7613 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
7614
7615 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
7616 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
7617 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
7618 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
7619 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
7620 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
7621 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
7622 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
7623 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
7624 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
7625
7626 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
7627
7628 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7629 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7630
7631 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
7632 "h1-case-adjust-file".
7633
7634
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007635option http-buffer-request
7636no option http-buffer-request
7637 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
7638 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7639 yes | yes | yes | yes
7640 Arguments : none
7641
7642 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
7643 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
7644 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
7645 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
7646 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
7647 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01007648 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
7649 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
7650 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
7651 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007652
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01007653 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007654
7655
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007656option http-ignore-probes
7657no option http-ignore-probes
7658 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
7659 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7660 yes | yes | yes | no
7661 Arguments : none
7662
7663 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
7664 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
7665 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
7666 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
7667 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
7668 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
7669 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
7670 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
7671 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007672 was received over a connection before it was closed;
7673 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007674 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
7675
7676 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
7677 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
7678 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
7679 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
7680 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
7681 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
7682 are often the only way to detect them.
7683
7684 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7685 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7686
7687 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
7688
7689
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007690option http-keep-alive
7691no option http-keep-alive
7692 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
7693 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7694 yes | yes | yes | yes
7695 Arguments : none
7696
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007697 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7698 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007699 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7700 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007701 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
7702 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
7703 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007704
7705 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
7706 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007707 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
7708 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
7709 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
7710 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
7711 situations where this option may be useful :
7712
7713 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007714 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007715
7716 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
7717 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
7718
7719 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
7720 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
7721 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
7722 request.
7723
7724 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
7725 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007726 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
7727 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
7728 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007729
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007730 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
7731 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
7732 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
7733 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
7734 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
7735 not set.
7736
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007737 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
7738 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
7739 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007740
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007741 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007742 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01007743 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007744
7745
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02007746option http-no-delay
7747no option http-no-delay
7748 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
7749 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7750 yes | yes | yes | yes
7751 Arguments : none
7752
7753 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
7754 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
7755 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
7756 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
7757 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
7758 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
7759 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
7760 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
7761 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
7762 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
7763 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
7764 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
7765 affected.
7766
7767 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
7768 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
7769 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
7770 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
7771 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
7772 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
7773 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
7774 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
7775 latency environments.
7776
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007777 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
7778
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02007779
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007780option http-pretend-keepalive
7781no option http-pretend-keepalive
7782 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
7783 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02007784 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007785 Arguments : none
7786
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007787 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007788 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
7789 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
7790 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
7791 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
7792 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
7793 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
7794 consider the response complete.
7795
7796 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
7797 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
7798 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
7799 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007800 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007801 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
7802
7803 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
7804 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
7805 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
7806 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
7807 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
7808 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
7809 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
7810
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02007811 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
7812 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
7813 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
7814 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
7815 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
7816 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007817
7818 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7819 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7820
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007821 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007822 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007823
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007824
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007825option http-server-close
7826no option http-server-close
7827 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
7828 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7829 yes | yes | yes | yes
7830 Arguments : none
7831
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007832 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7833 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
7834 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7835 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007836 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
7837 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
7838 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
7839 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
7840 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
7841 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
7842 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
7843 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
7844 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
7845 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
7846 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007847
7848 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
7849 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
7850 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
7851 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007852 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
7853 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007854
7855 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
7856 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007857 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
7858 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
7859 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007860
7861 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7862 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7863
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007864 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
7865 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007866
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007867option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007868no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007869 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
7870 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7871 yes | yes | yes | no
7872 Arguments : none
7873
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00007874 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007875 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
7876 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
7877 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
7878 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
7879 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
7880 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
7881
7882 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
7883 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01007884 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
7885 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
7886 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007887
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01007888 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
7889 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
7890 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
7891 front of an existing proxy.
7892
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007893 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
7894
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007895 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007896
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007897option httpchk
7898option httpchk <uri>
7899option httpchk <method> <uri>
7900option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02007901 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007902 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7903 yes | no | yes | yes
7904 Arguments :
7905 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
7906 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
7907 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
7908 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
7909 ones.
7910
7911 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
7912 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
7913 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
7914
7915 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
7916 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
7917 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02007918 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007919
7920 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
7921 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
7922 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
7923 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
7924 the lack of any response.
7925
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02007926 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
7927 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
7928 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
7929 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
7930
7931 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
7932 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
7933 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007934
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02007935 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
7936 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02007937 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007938 internally relies on an HTX multiplexer. Thus, it means the request
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02007939 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007940
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02007941 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
7942 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
7943 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
7944 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
7945
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007946 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02007947 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
7948 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
7949 backend https_relay
7950 mode tcp
7951 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
7952 http-check send hdr Host www
7953 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007954
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09007955 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
7956 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
7957 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007958
7959
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007960option httpclose
7961no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007962 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007963 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7964 yes | yes | yes | yes
7965 Arguments : none
7966
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007967 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7968 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
7969 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7970 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007971 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007972
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007973 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
7974 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05007975 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007976 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
7977 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007978
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007979 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
7980 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
7981 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007982
7983 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
7984 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007985 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
7986 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
7987 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007988
7989 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7990 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7991
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007992 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007993
7994
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007995option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007996 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
7997 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01007998 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007999 Arguments :
8000 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
8001 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
8002 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008003 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008004 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008005
8006 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8007 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8008 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
8009 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
8010 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
8011 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
8012 ports.
8013
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01008014 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
8015 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008016
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008017 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8018
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008019 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008020
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008021
8022option http_proxy
8023no option http_proxy
8024 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
8025 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8026 yes | yes | yes | yes
8027 Arguments : none
8028
8029 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
8030 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
8031 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
8032 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
8033 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
8034
8035 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
8036 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008037 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
8038 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008039
8040 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8041 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8042
8043 Example :
8044 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
8045 backend direct_forward
8046 option httpclose
8047 option http_proxy
8048
8049 See also : "option httpclose"
8050
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008051
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008052option independent-streams
8053no option independent-streams
8054 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008055 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8056 yes | yes | yes | yes
8057 Arguments : none
8058
8059 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
8060 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
8061 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
8062 receive data or not.
8063
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008064 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008065 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
8066 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
8067 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
8068 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
8069 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
8070 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
8071 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
8072 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
8073 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
8074 socket buffers.
8075
8076 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
8077 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
8078 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
8079 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
8080 slow lines, so use it with caution.
8081
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008082 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008083
8084
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02008085option ldap-check
8086 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
8087 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8088 yes | no | yes | yes
8089 Arguments : none
8090
8091 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
8092 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
8093 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
8094 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
8095
8096 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
8097 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
8098
8099 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
8100 configure it.
8101
8102 Example :
8103 option ldap-check
8104
8105 See also : "option httpchk"
8106
8107
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008108option external-check
8109 Use external processes for server health checks
8110 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8111 yes | no | yes | yes
8112
8113 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
8114 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
8115 command".
8116
8117 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
8118
8119 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
8120
8121
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008122option log-health-checks
8123no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008124 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008125 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8126 yes | no | yes | yes
8127 Arguments : none
8128
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008129 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
8130 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
8131 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008132
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008133 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
8134 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
8135 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
8136 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
8137 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
8138
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008139 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008140 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008141
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008142 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
8143 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
8144 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008145
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008146
8147option log-separate-errors
8148no option log-separate-errors
8149 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
8150 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8151 yes | yes | yes | no
8152 Arguments : none
8153
8154 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
8155 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
8156 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
8157 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
8158 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
8159 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
8160 provides very important information.
8161
8162 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
8163 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
8164 error logs.
8165
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008166 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008167 logging.
8168
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008169
8170option logasap
8171no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008172 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008173 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8174 yes | yes | yes | no
8175 Arguments : none
8176
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008177 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
8178 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
8179 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
8180 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
8181
8182 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
8183 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
8184 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
8185 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
8186 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05008187 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008188 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
8189 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
8190 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
8191 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05008192 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008193
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008194 Examples :
8195 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
8196 mode http
8197 option httplog
8198 option logasap
8199 log 192.168.2.200 local3
8200
8201 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
8202 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
8203 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
8204 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
8205
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008206 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008207 logging.
8208
8209
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02008210option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008211 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008212 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8213 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008214 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008215 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
8216 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02008217 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
8218 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008219
8220 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
8221 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008222 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008223 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
8224 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
8225 in the MySQL table, like this :
8226
8227 USE mysql;
8228 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
8229 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
8230
8231 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008232 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008233 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
8234 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
8235 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
8236 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
8237 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
8238 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
8239 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
8240
8241 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
8242 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008243
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02008244 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008245
8246 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
8247 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
8248 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
8249 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02008250 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
8251 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008252
8253 See also: "option httpchk"
8254
8255
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008256option nolinger
8257no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008258 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008259 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8260 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008261 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008262
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008263 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008264 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
8265 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
8266 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
8267 connections.
8268
8269 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
8270 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
8271 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
8272 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
8273 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
8274 this too.
8275
8276 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
8277 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
8278 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
8279
8280 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
8281 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
8282 for servers.
8283
8284 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8285 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8286
8287
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008288option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
8289 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
8290 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8291 yes | yes | yes | yes
8292 Arguments :
8293 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
8294 matching <network>
8295 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
8296 header name.
8297
8298 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
8299 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
8300 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
8301 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
8302 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
8303 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
8304 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
8305 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
8306 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
8307 possible that the client has already brought one.
8308
8309 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
8310 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
8311 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
8312 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
8313 header and requires different one.
8314
8315 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
8316 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
8317 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
8318 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
8319 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
8320 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
8321 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
8322
8323 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
8324 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
8325 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
8326 both are defined.
8327
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008328 Examples :
8329 # Original Destination address
8330 frontend www
8331 mode http
8332 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
8333
8334 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
8335 backend www
8336 mode http
8337 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
8338
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008339 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008340
8341
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008342option persist
8343no option persist
8344 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
8345 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8346 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008347 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008348
8349 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
8350 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
8351 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
8352 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
8353 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
8354 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
8355 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
8356 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
8357 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
8358 redirected to another valid server.
8359
8360 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8361 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8362
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01008363 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008364
8365
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01008366option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
8367 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
8368 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8369 yes | no | yes | yes
8370 Arguments :
8371 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
8372 PostgreSQL server.
8373
8374 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
8375 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
8376 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
8377 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
8378
8379 See also: "option httpchk"
8380
8381
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008382option prefer-last-server
8383no option prefer-last-server
8384 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
8385 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8386 yes | no | yes | yes
8387 Arguments : none
8388
8389 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
8390 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
8391 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
8392 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
8393 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
8394 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
8395 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
8396 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
8397 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01008398 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
8399 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02008400 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
8401 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
8402 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01008403 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
8404 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
8405 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008406
8407 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8408 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8409
8410 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
8411
8412
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008413option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008414option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008415no option redispatch
8416 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
8417 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8418 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008419 Arguments :
8420 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
8421 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
8422 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008423 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008424 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008425 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008426 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
8427 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
8428 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
8429
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008430
8431 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
8432 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
8433 be able to access the service anymore.
8434
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01008435 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
8436 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008437
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02008438 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
8439 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
8440 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
8441 following order:
8442
8443 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
8444
8445 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
8446 list, or
8447
8448 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
8449
8450 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
8451 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
8452
8453 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
8454 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
8455 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
8456 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
8457
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008458 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008459 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
8460 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008461
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008462 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8463 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8464
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008465 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008466
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008467
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02008468option redis-check
8469 Use redis health checks for server testing
8470 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8471 yes | no | yes | yes
8472 Arguments : none
8473
8474 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
8475 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
8476 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
8477 find the "+PONG" response message.
8478
8479 Example :
8480 option redis-check
8481
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03008482 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02008483
8484
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008485option smtpchk
8486option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
8487 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
8488 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8489 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008490 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008491 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02008492 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008493 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
8494
8495 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
8496 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
8497 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
8498
8499 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
8500 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
8501 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
8502 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
8503 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
8504 dead server.
8505
8506 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
8507 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008508 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008509 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
8510
8511 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
8512 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
8513 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
8514 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02008515 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008516
8517 Example :
8518 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
8519
8520 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
8521
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008522
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02008523option socket-stats
8524no option socket-stats
8525
8526 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
8527 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8528 yes | yes | yes | no
8529
8530 Arguments : none
8531
8532
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008533option splice-auto
8534no option splice-auto
8535 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
8536 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8537 yes | yes | yes | yes
8538 Arguments : none
8539
8540 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
8541 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008542 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008543 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008544 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008545 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
8546 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
8547 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
8548 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8549
8550 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
8551 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
8552 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
8553 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
8554 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
8555 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
8556 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
8557 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
8558 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
8559 keyword.
8560
8561 Example :
8562 option splice-auto
8563
8564 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8565 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8566
8567 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
8568 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8569
8570
8571option splice-request
8572no option splice-request
8573 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
8574 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8575 yes | yes | yes | yes
8576 Arguments : none
8577
8578 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008579 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008580 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
8581 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
8582 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
8583 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8584
8585 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
8586
8587 Example :
8588 option splice-request
8589
8590 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8591 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8592
8593 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
8594 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8595
8596
8597option splice-response
8598no option splice-response
8599 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
8600 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8601 yes | yes | yes | yes
8602 Arguments : none
8603
8604 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008605 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008606 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
8607 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
8608 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
8609 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8610
8611 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
8612
8613 Example :
8614 option splice-response
8615
8616 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8617 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8618
8619 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
8620 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8621
8622
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01008623option spop-check
8624 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
8625 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8626 no | no | no | yes
8627 Arguments : none
8628
8629 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
8630 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
8631 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
8632 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
8633
8634 Example :
8635 option spop-check
8636
8637 See also : "option httpchk"
8638
8639
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008640option srvtcpka
8641no option srvtcpka
8642 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
8643 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8644 yes | no | yes | yes
8645 Arguments : none
8646
8647 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8648 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008649 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008650 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8651
8652 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8653 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8654 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8655 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8656
8657 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8658 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8659 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8660 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8661 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8662
8663 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8664
8665 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
8666 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
8667 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
8668
8669 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8670 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8671
8672 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
8673
8674
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008675option ssl-hello-chk
8676 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
8677 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8678 yes | no | yes | yes
8679 Arguments : none
8680
8681 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
8682 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
8683 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
8684 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
8685 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
8686 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
8687 hello message.
8688
8689 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
8690 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
8691 messages, which is appreciable.
8692
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008693 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
8694 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
8695 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008696
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008697 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
8698
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008699
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008700option tcp-check
8701 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
8702 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8703 yes | no | yes | yes
8704
8705 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
8706 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
8707
8708 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
8709 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
8710 attempt, which remains the default mode.
8711
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008712 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008713 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
8714 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
8715 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
8716 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
8717 only.
8718
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008719 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008720 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
8721 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
8722 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
8723 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
8724
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008725 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008726 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
8727 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008728 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008729 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
8730 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
8731 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
8732 the respective protocols.
8733 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008734 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008735
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008736 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008737
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008738 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
8739 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
8740 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
8741 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008742
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008743 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
8744 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
8745 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01008746
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008747
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008748 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008749 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008750 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008751 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008752
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008753 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008754 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008755 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008756
8757 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
8758 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008759 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008760 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008761 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008762 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02008763 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008764 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008765 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8766 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008767 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008768 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
8769 tcp-check expect string +OK
8770
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008771 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008772 (send many headers before analyzing)
8773 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008774 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008775 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
8776 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
8777 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
8778 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008779 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008780
8781
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008782 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008783
8784
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008785option tcp-smart-accept
8786no option tcp-smart-accept
8787 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
8788 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8789 yes | yes | yes | no
8790 Arguments : none
8791
8792 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
8793 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
8794 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
8795 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
8796 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
8797 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
8798
8799 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
8800 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
8801 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
8802 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
8803
8804 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
8805 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
8806 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008807 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008808
8809 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
8810 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
8811 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
8812
8813 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
8814 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
8815 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
8816
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02008817 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
8818
8819
8820option tcp-smart-connect
8821no option tcp-smart-connect
8822 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
8823 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8824 yes | no | yes | yes
8825 Arguments : none
8826
8827 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
8828 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
8829 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
8830 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
8831 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
8832
8833 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
8834 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
8835 complex.
8836
8837 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
8838 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
8839 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
8840
8841 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8842 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8843
8844 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
8845
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008846
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008847option tcpka
8848 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
8849 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8850 yes | yes | yes | yes
8851 Arguments : none
8852
8853 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8854 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008855 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008856 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8857
8858 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8859 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8860 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8861 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8862
8863 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8864 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8865 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8866 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8867 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8868
8869 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8870
8871 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
8872 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
8873 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
8874 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
8875 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
8876 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
8877 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
8878 backends.
8879
8880 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
8881
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008882
8883option tcplog
8884 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
8885 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008886 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008887 Arguments : none
8888
8889 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8890 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8891 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
8892 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
8893 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
8894 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
8895 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
8896 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
8897
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008898 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8899
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008900 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008901
8902
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008903option transparent
8904no option transparent
8905 Enable client-side transparent proxying
8906 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01008907 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008908 Arguments : none
8909
8910 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
8911 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
8912 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
8913 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
8914 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
8915 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
8916 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
8917 appropriate server.
8918
8919 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
8920 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
8921
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01008922 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008923 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008924
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008925
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008926external-check command <command>
8927 Executable to run when performing an external-check
8928 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8929 yes | no | yes | yes
8930
8931 Arguments :
8932 <command> is the external command to run
8933
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008934 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
8935
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01008936 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008937
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01008938 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
8939 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
8940 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
8941 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
8942 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
8943 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008944
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01008945 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
8946
8947 Environment variables :
8948 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
8949 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
8950
8951 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
8952
8953 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
8954
8955 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
8956 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
8957 for a UNIX socket).
8958
8959 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
8960
8961 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
8962
8963 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
8964
8965 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
8966
8967 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
8968
8969 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
8970 socket).
8971
8972 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
8973 the command may be set using "external-check path".
8974
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02008975 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
8976
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008977 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
8978 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
8979 failed.
8980
8981 Example :
8982 external-check command /bin/true
8983
8984 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
8985
8986
8987external-check path <path>
8988 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
8989 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8990 yes | no | yes | yes
8991
8992 Arguments :
8993 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
8994
8995 The default path is "".
8996
8997 Example :
8998 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
8999
9000 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
9001 "external-check command"
9002
9003
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009004persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009005persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009006 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
9007 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9008 yes | no | yes | yes
9009 Arguments :
9010 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009011 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
9012 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009013
9014 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
9015 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009016 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009017 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
9018 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
9019 forwarded to this server.
9020
9021 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
9022 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
9023 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009024 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009025 a single "listen" section.
9026
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009027 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
9028 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
9029 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
9030
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009031 Example :
9032 listen tse-farm
9033 bind :3389
9034 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
9035 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9036 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
9037 # apply RDP cookie persistence
9038 persist rdp-cookie
9039 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009040 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009041 balance rdp-cookie
9042 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
9043 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
9044
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009045 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
9046 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009047
9048
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009049rate-limit sessions <rate>
9050 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
9051 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9052 yes | yes | yes | no
9053 Arguments :
9054 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
9055 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
9056
9057 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
9058 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
9059 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
9060 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
9061 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
9062 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
9063
9064 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
9065 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
9066 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
9067 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
9068
9069 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
9070 listen smtp
9071 mode tcp
9072 bind :25
9073 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02009074 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009075
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02009076 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
9077 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
9078 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009079
9080 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
9081
9082
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009083redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9084redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9085redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009086 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
9087 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9088 no | yes | yes | yes
9089
9090 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01009091 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009092
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009093 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009094 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009095 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
9096 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
9097 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009098
9099 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
9100 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
9101 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
9102 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
9103 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009104 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
9105 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
9106 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
9107 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009108
9109 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
9110 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
9111 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
9112 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
9113 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
9114 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009115 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009116 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009117 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
9118 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
9119 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009120
9121 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01009122 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
9123 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
9124 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02009125 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01009126 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
9127 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
9128 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
9129 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009130
9131 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009132 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009133
9134 - "drop-query"
9135 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
9136 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
9137 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
9138 with a location-type redirect.
9139
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01009140 - "append-slash"
9141 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
9142 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
9143 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
9144 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
9145
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009146 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
9147 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
9148 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
9149 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
9150 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
9151 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
9152 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
9153
9154 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
9155 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
9156 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
9157 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
9158 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
9159 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
9160 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009161
9162 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
9163 acl clear dst_port 80
9164 acl secure dst_port 8080
9165 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009166 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01009167 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009168 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
9169
9170 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01009171 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
9172 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
9173 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009174 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009175
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01009176 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
9177 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
9178 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
9179
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009180 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01009181 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009182
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009183 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02009184 http-request redirect code 301 location \
9185 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
9186 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009187
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009188 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009189
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01009190
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02009191retries <value>
9192 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
9193 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9194 yes | no | yes | yes
9195 Arguments :
9196 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
9197 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
9198 default value is 3.
9199
9200 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
9201 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
9202 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
9203
9204 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009205 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
9206 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02009207
9208 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
9209 server even if a cookie references a different server.
9210
9211 See also : "option redispatch"
9212
9213
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009214retry-on [list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +02009215 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
9216 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
9217 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009218 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9219 yes | no | yes | yes
9220 Arguments :
9221 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
9222 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
9223 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
9224 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
9225
9226 none never retry
9227
9228 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
9229 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
9230
9231 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
9232 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
9233 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
9234 request timeout on the server side, poor network
9235 condition, or a server crash or restart while
9236 processing the request.
9237
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02009238 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
9239 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
9240 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
9241 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
9242 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
9243 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
9244 overflow attack for example).
9245
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009246 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
9247 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
9248 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
9249 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
9250 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
9251 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
9252 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
9253 amplify denial of service attacks.
9254
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02009255 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
9256 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
9257 considered to be safe to retry.
9258
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009259 <status> any HTTP status code among "404" (Not Found), "408"
9260 (Request Timeout), "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server
9261 Error), "501" (Not Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway),
9262 "503" (Service Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
9263
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02009264 all-retryable-errors
9265 retry request for any error that are considered
9266 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
9267 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
9268 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
9269
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009270 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
9271 not cumulative.
9272
9273 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
9274 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
9275 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
9276 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
9277
9278 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
9279 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
9280 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
9281 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
9282 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
9283 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
9284 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
9285 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
9286 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
9287 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
9288 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
9289 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
9290
9291 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
9292 should not use this directive.
9293
9294 The default is "conn-failure".
9295
9296 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
9297
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01009298server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009299 Declare a server in a backend
9300 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9301 no | no | yes | yes
9302 Arguments :
9303 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009304 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05009305 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009306
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01009307 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
9308 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
9309 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
9310 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02009311 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
9312 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
9313 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
9314 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
9315 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009316 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
9317 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
9318 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
9319 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
9320 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
9321 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
9322 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02009323 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02009324 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
9325 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
9326 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
9327 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
9328 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
9329 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02009330 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
9331 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01009332 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
9333 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009334
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009335 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009336 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
9337 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
9338 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
9339 adding this value to the client's port.
9340
9341 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
9342 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009343 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009344
9345 Examples :
9346 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
9347 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009348 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02009349 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
9350 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
9351 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009352
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02009353 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
9354 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
9355 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
9356 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
9357 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
9358
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05009359 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
9360 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009361
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02009362server-state-file-name [<file>]
9363 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
9364 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
9365 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
9366 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
9367 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
9368 global directive "server-state-file-base".
9369
9370 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
9371 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
9372
9373 global
9374 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
9375
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +01009376 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02009377 load-server-state-from-file
9378
9379 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
9380 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009381
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02009382server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
9383 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
9384 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
9385 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9386 no | no | yes | yes
9387
9388 Arguments:
9389 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
9390
9391 <num | range>
9392 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
9393 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
9394 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
9395 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
9396
9397 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
9398
9399 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
9400
9401 <params*>
9402 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
9403 keyword.
9404
9405 Examples:
9406 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
9407 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
9408 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
9409
9410 # or
9411 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
9412
9413 # would be equivalent to:
9414 server srv1 google.com:80 check
9415 server srv2 google.com:80 check
9416 server srv3 google.com:80 check
9417
9418
9419
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009420source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009421source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01009422source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009423 Set the source address for outgoing connections
9424 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9425 yes | no | yes | yes
9426 Arguments :
9427 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
9428 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009429
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009430 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009431 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
9432 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
9433 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
9434 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
9435 supported prefixes are :
9436 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
9437 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
9438 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02009439 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02009440 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
9441 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009442
9443 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
9444 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009445 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
9446 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
9447 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009448
9449 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
9450 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
9451 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
9452 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
9453 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
9454 <addr>.
9455
9456 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
9457 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
9458 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
9459 port.
9460
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009461 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
9462 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
9463 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
9464 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01009465 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009466 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
9467 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
9468 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
9469 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
9470 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
9471 HTTP header.
9472
9473 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
9474 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009475 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009476 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
9477 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
9478 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
9479 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
9480 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
9481 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
9482 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
9483
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01009484 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
9485 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
9486 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
9487 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
9488 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
9489 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
9490
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009491 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
9492 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
9493 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
9494 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
9495
9496 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
9497 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
9498 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
9499 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
9500 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
9501 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
9502
9503 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
9504 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
9505 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
9506 there are two methods :
9507
9508 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
9509 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
9510 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
9511 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
9512 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
9513 of the client ranges may be used.
9514
9515 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
9516 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
9517 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
9518 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
9519 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
9520 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
9521 same session.
9522
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009523 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
9524 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
9525 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009526 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009527
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02009528 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
9529
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009530 Examples :
9531 backend private
9532 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
9533 source 192.168.1.200
9534
9535 backend transparent_ssl1
9536 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
9537 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
9538
9539 backend transparent_ssl2
9540 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
9541 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
9542 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
9543
9544 backend transparent_ssl3
9545 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
9546 # is more conntrack-friendly.
9547 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
9548
9549 backend transparent_smtp
9550 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
9551 # with Tproxy version 4.
9552 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
9553
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009554 backend transparent_http
9555 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
9556 # proxy.
9557 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
9558
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009559 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009560 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
9561
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009562
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009563srvtcpka-cnt <count>
9564 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
9565 the connection on the server side.
9566 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9567 yes | no | yes | yes
9568 Arguments :
9569 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
9570
9571 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
9572 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02009573 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
9574 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009575
9576 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-idle", "srvtcpka-intvl".
9577
9578
9579srvtcpka-idle <timeout>
9580 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
9581 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
9582 server side.
9583 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9584 yes | no | yes | yes
9585 Arguments :
9586 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
9587 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
9588 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
9589 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
9590
9591 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
9592 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02009593 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
9594 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009595
9596 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-intvl".
9597
9598
9599srvtcpka-intvl <timeout>
9600 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the server side.
9601 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9602 yes | no | yes | yes
9603 Arguments :
9604 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
9605 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
9606 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
9607 document.
9608
9609 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
9610 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02009611 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
9612 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009613
9614 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-idle".
9615
9616
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009617stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
9618 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
9619 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009620 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009621
9622 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
9623 matched.
9624
9625 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
9626 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
9627
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009628 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9629 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009630 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009631
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01009632 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
9633 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
9634 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
9635 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009636
9637 Example :
9638 # statistics admin level only for localhost
9639 backend stats_localhost
9640 stats enable
9641 stats admin if LOCALHOST
9642
9643 Example :
9644 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
9645 backend stats_auth
9646 stats enable
9647 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
9648 stats admin if TRUE
9649
9650 Example :
9651 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
9652 userlist stats-auth
9653 group admin users admin
9654 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
9655 group readonly users haproxy
9656 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
9657
9658 backend stats_auth
9659 stats enable
9660 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
9661 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
9662 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
9663 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
9664
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009665 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
9666 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
9667 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009668
9669
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009670stats auth <user>:<passwd>
9671 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
9672 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009673 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009674 Arguments :
9675 <user> is a user name to grant access to
9676
9677 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
9678
9679 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
9680 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
9681 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
9682 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
9683 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
9684 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
9685
9686 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
9687 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
9688 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02009689 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009690
9691 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
9692 report using "stats scope".
9693
9694 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9695 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9696 unobvious parameters.
9697
9698 Example :
9699 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9700 backend public_www
9701 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9702 stats enable
9703 stats hide-version
9704 stats scope .
9705 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009706 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009707 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9708 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9709
9710 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9711 backend private_monitoring
9712 stats enable
9713 stats uri /admin?stats
9714 stats refresh 5s
9715
9716 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
9717
9718
9719stats enable
9720 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
9721 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009722 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009723 Arguments : none
9724
9725 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
9726 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
9727 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
9728 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
9729 - stats auth : no authentication
9730 - stats scope : no restriction
9731
9732 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9733 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9734 unobvious parameters.
9735
9736 Example :
9737 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9738 backend public_www
9739 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9740 stats enable
9741 stats hide-version
9742 stats scope .
9743 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009744 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009745 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9746 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9747
9748 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9749 backend private_monitoring
9750 stats enable
9751 stats uri /admin?stats
9752 stats refresh 5s
9753
9754 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9755
9756
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009757stats hide-version
9758 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009759 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009760 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009761 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009762
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009763 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
9764 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
9765 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
9766 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
9767 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
9768 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009769
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02009770 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9771 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9772 unobvious parameters.
9773
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009774 Example :
9775 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9776 backend public_www
9777 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02009778 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009779 stats hide-version
9780 stats scope .
9781 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009782 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009783 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9784 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009785
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009786 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9787 backend private_monitoring
9788 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009789 stats uri /admin?stats
9790 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01009791
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009792 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009793
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01009794
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02009795stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
9796 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
9797 Access control for statistics
9798
9799 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9800 no | no | yes | yes
9801
9802 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
9803 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
9804 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
9805 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
9806 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
9807 should be asked to enter a username and password.
9808
9809 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
9810 instance.
9811
9812 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
9813 about ACL usage.
9814
9815
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009816stats realm <realm>
9817 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
9818 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009819 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009820 Arguments :
9821 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
9822 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
9823 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
9824
9825 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
9826 using a backslash ('\').
9827
9828 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
9829 only related to authentication.
9830
9831 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9832 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9833 unobvious parameters.
9834
9835 Example :
9836 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9837 backend public_www
9838 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9839 stats enable
9840 stats hide-version
9841 stats scope .
9842 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009843 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009844 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9845 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9846
9847 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9848 backend private_monitoring
9849 stats enable
9850 stats uri /admin?stats
9851 stats refresh 5s
9852
9853 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
9854
9855
9856stats refresh <delay>
9857 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
9858 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009859 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009860 Arguments :
9861 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
9862 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
9863 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
9864 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
9865 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
9866 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
9867
9868 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
9869 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
9870 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
Jackie Tapia749f74c2020-07-22 18:59:40 -05009871 they want automatic refresh of the page or not.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009872
9873 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9874 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9875 unobvious parameters.
9876
9877 Example :
9878 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9879 backend public_www
9880 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9881 stats enable
9882 stats hide-version
9883 stats scope .
9884 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009885 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009886 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9887 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9888
9889 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9890 backend private_monitoring
9891 stats enable
9892 stats uri /admin?stats
9893 stats refresh 5s
9894
9895 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9896
9897
9898stats scope { <name> | "." }
9899 Enable statistics and limit access scope
9900 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009901 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009902 Arguments :
9903 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
9904 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
9905 section in which the statement appears.
9906
9907 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
9908 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
9909 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
9910 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
9911 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
9912 exists.
9913
9914 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9915 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9916 unobvious parameters.
9917
9918 Example :
9919 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9920 backend public_www
9921 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9922 stats enable
9923 stats hide-version
9924 stats scope .
9925 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009926 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009927 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9928 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9929
9930 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9931 backend private_monitoring
9932 stats enable
9933 stats uri /admin?stats
9934 stats refresh 5s
9935
9936 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9937
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009938
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009939stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009940 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
9941 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009942 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009943
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009944 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009945 description from global section is automatically used instead.
9946
9947 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
9948 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
9949
9950 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9951 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009952 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009953
9954 Example :
9955 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9956 backend private_monitoring
9957 stats enable
9958 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
9959 stats uri /admin?stats
9960 stats refresh 5s
9961
9962 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
9963 global section.
9964
9965
9966stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009967 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
9968 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9969 yes | yes | yes | yes
9970 Arguments : none
9971
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009972 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009973 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
9974 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
9975 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
9976 - IP (socket, server)
9977 - cookie (backend, server)
9978
9979 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9980 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009981 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009982
9983 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
9984
9985
9986stats show-node [ <name> ]
9987 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
9988 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009989 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009990 Arguments:
9991 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
9992 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
9993
9994 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
9995 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009996 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009997
9998 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9999 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10000 unobvious parameters.
10001
10002 Example:
10003 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10004 backend private_monitoring
10005 stats enable
10006 stats show-node Europe-1
10007 stats uri /admin?stats
10008 stats refresh 5s
10009
10010 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
10011 section.
10012
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010013
10014stats uri <prefix>
10015 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
10016 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010017 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010018 Arguments :
10019 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
10020 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
10021 query string.
10022
10023 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
10024 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
10025 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
10026 possible to reach it in the application.
10027
10028 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010029 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010030 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
10031 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
10032 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
10033 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
10034
10035 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
10036 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
10037 an address or a port to statistics only.
10038
10039 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10040 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10041 unobvious parameters.
10042
10043 Example :
10044 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10045 backend public_www
10046 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10047 stats enable
10048 stats hide-version
10049 stats scope .
10050 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010051 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010052 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10053 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10054
10055 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10056 backend private_monitoring
10057 stats enable
10058 stats uri /admin?stats
10059 stats refresh 5s
10060
10061 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
10062
10063
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010064stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
10065 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010066 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010067 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010068
10069 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010070 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010071 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010072 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010073 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
10074
10075 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10076 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10077 the "stick-table" statement.
10078
10079 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
10080 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
10081 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
10082 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
10083 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
10084
10085 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10086 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
10087 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
10088 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
10089 transformation rules.
10090
10091 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10092 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10093 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10094 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10095 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10096 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10097 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10098
10099 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
10100 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
10101 ACL based conditions.
10102
10103 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
10104 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
10105 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
10106 matches can be used as fallbacks.
10107
10108 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
10109 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
10110 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
10111 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
10112
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010113 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10114 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010115 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010116
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010117 Example :
10118 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
10119 # last 30 minutes
10120 backend pop
10121 mode tcp
10122 balance roundrobin
10123 stick store-request src
10124 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10125 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
10126 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
10127
10128 backend smtp
10129 mode tcp
10130 balance roundrobin
10131 stick match src table pop
10132 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
10133 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
10134
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010135 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010136 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010137
10138
10139stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
10140 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
10141 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10142 no | no | yes | yes
10143
10144 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
10145 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
10146 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
10147 for writing more maintainable configurations.
10148
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010149 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10150 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010151 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010152
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010153 Examples :
10154 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +010010155 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010156
10157 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
10158 stick match src table pop if !localhost
10159 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
10160
10161
10162 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
10163 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
10164 backend http
10165 mode http
10166 balance roundrobin
10167 stick on src table https
10168 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
10169 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
10170 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
10171
10172 backend https
10173 mode tcp
10174 balance roundrobin
10175 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10176 stick on src
10177 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
10178 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
10179
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010180 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010181
10182
10183stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
10184 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
10185 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10186 no | no | yes | yes
10187
10188 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010189 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010190 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010191 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010192 server is selected.
10193
10194 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10195 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10196 the "stick-table" statement.
10197
10198 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
10199 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
10200 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
10201 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
10202 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
10203 address.
10204
10205 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10206 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
10207 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
10208 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
10209 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
10210 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
10211 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
10212 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
10213 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
10214 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
10215
10216 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10217 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10218 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10219 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10220 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10221 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10222 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10223
10224 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
10225 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
10226 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
10227 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
10228
10229 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
10230 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
10231 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
10232 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
10233 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
10234 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010010235 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
10236 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
10237 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
10238 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
10239 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
10240 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010241
10242 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
10243 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
10244 the request.
10245
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010246 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10247 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010248 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010249
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010250 Example :
10251 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
10252 # last 30 minutes
10253 backend pop
10254 mode tcp
10255 balance roundrobin
10256 stick store-request src
10257 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10258 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
10259 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
10260
10261 backend smtp
10262 mode tcp
10263 balance roundrobin
10264 stick match src table pop
10265 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
10266 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
10267
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010268 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010269 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010270
10271
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010272stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020010273 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
10274 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080010275 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010276 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020010277 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010278
10279 Arguments :
10280 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
10281 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
10282 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
10283 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
10284
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010010285 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
10286 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
10287 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
10288 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
10289
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010290 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
10291 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
10292 instance.
10293
10294 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
10295 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
10296 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
10297 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
10298 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
10299 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010300 to 32 characters.
10301
10302 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
10303 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
10304 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010305 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010306 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
10307 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010308
10309 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010310 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
10311 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010312 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
10313 increase.
10314
10315 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010316 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
10317 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
10318 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010319
10320 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
10321 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
10322 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
10323 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010324 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010325 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
10326 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
10327 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
10328 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
10329 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
10330 parameter (see below).
10331
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020010332 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
10333 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
10334 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
10335 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
10336 soft restart.
10337
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +020010338 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
10339 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010340
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010341 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
10342 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
10343 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
10344 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +030010345 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010346 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010347 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
10348 if not expiration delay is specified.
10349
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020010350 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
10351 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
10352 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
10353 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010354 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
10355 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
10356 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
10357 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
10358 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
10359 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
10360 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
10361 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
10362 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
10363 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
10364 types and their arguments.
10365
10366 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
10367 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
10368 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
10369 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
10370
10371 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
10372 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
10373 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010374 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010375
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010376 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
10377 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
10378 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010379 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010380 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010381 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010382
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010383 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
10384 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
10385 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
10386 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
10387
10388 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
10389 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
10390 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
10391 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
10392 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
10393 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
10394
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010395 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
10396 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
10397 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
10398 they were received.
10399
10400 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10401 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
10402 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
10403 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
10404 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
10405
10406 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10407 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10408 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10409 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
10410 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10411
10412 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
10413 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
10414 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
10415
10416 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10417 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10418 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10419 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
10420 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10421
10422 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10423 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
10424 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
10425 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
10426 the client side.
10427
10428 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10429 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10430 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10431 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
10432 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
10433 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
10434 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
10435
10436 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10437 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
10438 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
10439 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
10440 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
10441 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010442 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010443
10444 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10445 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10446 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10447 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
10448 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
10449 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10450
10451 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010452 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010453 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
10454 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
10455
10456 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10457 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10458 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10459 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
10460 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
10461 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
10462 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
10463 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
10464 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
10465 recommended for better fairness.
10466
10467 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010468 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010469 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
10470 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
10471
10472 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
10473 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10474 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10475 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
10476 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
10477 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
10478 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
10479 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
10480 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
10481 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020010482
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020010483 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
10484 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010485 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
10486 reference it.
10487
10488 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
10489 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010010490 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
10491 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
10492 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010493
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010494 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
10495 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
10496 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
10497 something that can be ignored.
10498
10499 Example:
10500 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
10501 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
10502 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
10503 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
10504
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +030010505 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010010506 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010507
10508
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010509stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010010510 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010511 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10512 no | no | yes | yes
10513
10514 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010515 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010516 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010517 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010518 server is selected.
10519
10520 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10521 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10522 the "stick-table" statement.
10523
10524 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
10525 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
10526 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
10527 when the response is a SSL server hello.
10528
10529 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10530 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
10531 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
10532 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
10533 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
10534 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010535 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010536 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
10537 rules.
10538
10539 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10540 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10541 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10542 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10543 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10544 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10545 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10546
10547 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
10548 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
10549 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
10550 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
10551
10552 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
10553 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
10554 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
10555 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
10556 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
10557 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010010558 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
10559 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
10560 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
10561 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
10562 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
10563 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
10564 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
10565 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
10566 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010567
10568 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
10569
10570 Example :
10571 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
10572 backend https
10573 mode tcp
10574 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010575 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010576 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010577
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010578 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
10579 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
10580
10581 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
10582 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10583 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
10584
10585 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
10586 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010587
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010588 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
10589 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
10590 # at offset 44.
10591
10592 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
10593 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
10594
10595 # Learn on response if server hello.
10596 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010597
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010598 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
10599 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
10600
10601 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
10602 extraction.
10603
10604
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010605tcp-check comment <string>
10606 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
10607 it fails.
10608 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10609 yes | no | yes | yes
10610
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010611 Arguments :
10612 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
10613 rule fails.
10614
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010615 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
10616 user-friendly error reporting.
10617
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010618 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
10619 "tcp-check expect".
10620
10621
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010622tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
10623 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020010624 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010625 Opens a new connection
10626 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010627 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010628
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010629 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010630 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
10631
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020010632 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040010633 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020010634
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020010635 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010636 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
10637 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020010638 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010639
10640 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010641
10642 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
10643
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020010644 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
10645
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010646 ssl opens a ciphered connection
10647
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020010648 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
10649
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020010650 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
10651 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
10652 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
10653 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
10654
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020010655 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
10656 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
10657 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
10658 haproxy -vv.
10659
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010660 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010661
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010662 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
10663 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
10664 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
10665
10666 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
10667 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
10668 of the sequence.
10669
10670 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
10671 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
10672 do.
10673
10674 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
10675 unset-var or comment rules.
10676
10677 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010678 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
10679 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
10680 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
10681 option tcp-check
10682 tcp-check connect
10683 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
10684 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
10685 tcp-check send \r\n
10686 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
10687 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
10688 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
10689 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
10690 tcp-check send \r\n
10691 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
10692 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
10693
10694 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
10695 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010696 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010697 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
10698 tcp-check connect port 143
10699 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
10700 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
10701
10702 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
10703
10704
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010705tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010706 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020010707 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010708 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010709 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010710 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010711 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010712
10713 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010714 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
10715
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010716 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
10717 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
10718 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
10719 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
10720 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
10721 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
10722 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
10723 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
10724 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
10725 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
10726
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010727 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010728 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
10729 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010730 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
10731 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
10732 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
10733
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010734 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
10735 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
10736 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020010737 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
10738 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
10739 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, for
10740 example 404 with disable-on-404
10741 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
10742 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010743 By default "L7OK" is used.
10744
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010745 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
10746 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020010747 "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are supported :
10748 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
10749 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
10750 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
10751 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
10752 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010753
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010754 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010755 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020010756 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
10757 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
10758 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
10759 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010760 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
10761
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020010762 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
10763 informational message reported in logs if the expect
10764 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
10765 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
10766
10767 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
10768 informational message reported in logs if an error
10769 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
10770 log-format string.
10771
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020010772 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
10773 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
10774 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10775 followed by some converters.
10776
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010777 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
10778 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
10779 with the usual backslash ('\').
10780 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010781 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010782 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
10783 used upper or lower case.
10784
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010785 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
10786
10787 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
10788 A health check response will be considered valid if the
10789 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
10790 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
10791 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
10792 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
10793 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
10794 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
10795
10796 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
10797 A health check response will be considered valid if the
10798 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
10799 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
10800 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
10801 expression.
10802
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020010803 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
10804 A health check response will be considered valid if the
10805 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
10806 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
10807 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
10808 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
10809
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010810 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
10811 in the response buffer. A health check response will
10812 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
10813 this exact hexadecimal string.
10814 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
10815
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010816 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
10817 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
10818 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
10819 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
10820 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
10821 size of the original response. As such, the expected
10822 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
10823 size.
10824
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020010825 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
10826 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
10827 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
10828 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
10829 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
10830 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
10831 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
10832 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
10833 in a binary string before matching the response's
10834 buffer.
10835
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010836 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
10837 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
10838 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
10839 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
10840 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
10841 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
10842 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
10843 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
10844 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
10845 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
10846 the null character.
10847
10848 Examples :
10849 # perform a POP check
10850 option tcp-check
10851 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
10852
10853 # perform an IMAP check
10854 option tcp-check
10855 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
10856
10857 # look for the redis master server
10858 option tcp-check
10859 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020010860 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010861 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
10862 tcp-check expect string role:master
10863 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
10864 tcp-check expect string +OK
10865
10866
10867 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
10868 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
10869
10870
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010871tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
10872tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
10873 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
10874 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010875 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010876 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010877
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010878 Arguments :
10879 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
10880
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010881 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
10882 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020010883
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010884 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
10885 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010886
10887 Examples :
10888 # look for the redis master server
10889 option tcp-check
10890 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
10891 tcp-check expect string role:master
10892
10893 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
10894 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
10895
10896
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010897tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
10898tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
10899 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
10900 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010901 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010902 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010903
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010904 Arguments :
10905 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010906
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010907 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
10908 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020010909
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010910 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
10911 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
10912 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010913
10914 Examples :
10915 # redis check in binary
10916 option tcp-check
10917 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
10918 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
10919
10920
10921 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
10922 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
10923
10924
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010925tcp-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010926 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010927 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010928 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010929
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010930 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010931 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
10932 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
10933 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
10934 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
10935 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
10936 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
10937 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
10938 and '-'.
10939
10940 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
10941
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010942 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010943 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
10944
10945
10946tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010947 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010948 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010949 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010950
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010951 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010952 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
10953 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
10954 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
10955 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
10956 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
10957 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
10958 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
10959 and '-'.
10960
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010961 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010962 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
10963
10964
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010965tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10966 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020010967 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10968 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010969 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010970 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10971 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020010972
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010973 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010974
10975 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
10976 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010977 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
10978 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
10979 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
10980 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
10981 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
10982 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010983
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010984 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
10985 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
10986 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
10987 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010988
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020010989 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010990 - accept :
10991 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10992 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10993 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010994
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010995 - reject :
10996 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10997 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10998 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
10999 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
11000 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
11001 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
11002 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
11003 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
11004 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
11005 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
11006 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011007 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011008
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011009 - expect-proxy layer4 :
11010 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
11011 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
11012 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
11013 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
11014 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
11015 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
11016 hosts.
11017
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010011018 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
11019 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
11020 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
11021 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
11022 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
11023 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
11024 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
11025 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
11026
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011027 - capture <sample> len <length> :
11028 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
11029 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
11030 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
11031 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
11032 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
11033 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
11034 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
11035 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011036 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
11037 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011038
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011039 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011040 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020011041 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
11042 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
11043 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011044 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020011045 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
11046 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
11047 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
11048 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
11049 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
11050 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
11051 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
11052 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011053
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011054 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011055 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011056 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011057 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011058 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
11059 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
11060 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011061
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011062 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
11063 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
11064 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
11065 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011066
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011067 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
11068 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
11069 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
11070 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
11071 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011072 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
11073 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
11074 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
11075 layer7 information is extracted.
11076
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011077 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
11078 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
11079 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
11080 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
11081 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011082
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011083 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
11084 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
11085 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
11086 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
11087
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011088 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
11089 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
11090 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
11091 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
11092
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011093 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
11094 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
11095 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
11096 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
11097 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011098
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011099 - set-src <expr> :
11100 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
11101 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
11102 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011103 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011104
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011105 Arguments:
11106 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11107 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011108
11109 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011110 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
11111
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011112 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
11113 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011114
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011115 - set-src-port <expr> :
11116 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
11117 expression.
11118
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011119 Arguments:
11120 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11121 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011122
11123 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011124 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
11125
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011126 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
11127 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
11128 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011129
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020011130 - set-dst <expr> :
11131 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
11132 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
11133 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
11134 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
11135 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
11136
11137 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11138 followed by some converters.
11139
11140 Example:
11141
11142 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
11143 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
11144
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011145 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
11146 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
11147
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020011148 - set-dst-port <expr> :
11149 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
11150 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
11151 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
11152
11153
11154 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11155 followed by some converters.
11156
11157 Example:
11158
11159 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
11160
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011161 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
11162 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
11163 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
11164
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011165 - "silent-drop" :
11166 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011167 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011168 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
11169 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
11170 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
11171 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
11172 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011173 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
11174 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011175 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
11176 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011177 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011178 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
11179 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
11180 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
11181 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
11182
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011183 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11184 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11185 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011186
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011187 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
11188 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
11189 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011190
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011191 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011192 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011193 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011194
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011195 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
11196 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
11197 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011198
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011199 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011200 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
11201 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011202
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011203 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
11204
11205 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
11206
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011207 See section 7 about ACL usage.
11208
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011209 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011210
11211
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011212tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11213 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011214 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011215 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011216 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011217 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11218 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011219
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011220 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011221
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011222 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011223 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
11224 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
11225 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
11226 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011227
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011228 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
11229 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
11230 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
11231 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011232 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
11233 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
11234 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
11235 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
11236 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
11237 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011238 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011239 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011240
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011241 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
11242 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
11243 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
11244 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011245
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011246 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011247 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010011248 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011249 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
11250 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040011251 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011252 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011253 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011254 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011255 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020011256 - set-dst <expr>
11257 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011258 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011259 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011260 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011261 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010011262 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011263
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011264 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
11265 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010011266 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
11267 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011268
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011269 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
11270 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
11271 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
11272 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
11273 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
11274 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011275
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011276 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011277 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11278 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011279
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011280 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020011281 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
11282 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
11283 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
11284 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011285 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
11286 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
11287 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011288
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011289 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011290 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
11291 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
11292 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011293
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020011294 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
11295 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
11296
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011297 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011298 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
11299 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011300
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011301 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
11302 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010011303 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011304 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11305 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011306 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011307 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011308 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011309 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
11310 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011311 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010011312 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
11313 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011314
11315 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11316 followed by some converters.
11317
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011318 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
11319 <var-name>.
11320
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040011321 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
11322 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
11323 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
11324 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
11325 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
11326
11327 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
11328 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
11329 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
11330 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
11331 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
11332 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
11333 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
11334 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
11335 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
11336 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
11337 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
11338
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011339 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
11340 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
11341 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
11342 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
11343 the SPOE agent name must be used.
11344
11345 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
11346
11347 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
11348
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010011349 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
11350 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
11351 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
11352 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
11353 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
11354 evaluated.
11355
11356 Example:
11357 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
11358
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011359 Example:
11360
11361 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011362 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011363
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011364 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011365 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
11366 # and reject everything else.
11367 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
11368 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020011369 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011370 tcp-request content reject
11371
11372 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011373 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
11374 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
11375 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011376 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011377
11378 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
11379 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
11380 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011381 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011382 tcp-request content reject
11383
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011384 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011385 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011386 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011387 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011388 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
11389 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011390
11391 Example:
11392 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
11393 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011394 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011395
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011396 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011397 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011398
11399 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011400 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011401 # protecting all our sites
11402 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011403 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
11404 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011405 ...
11406 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
11407
11408 backend http_dynamic
11409 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011410 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011411 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011412 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011413 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011414 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011415 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011416
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011417 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011418
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030011419 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
11420 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011421
11422
11423tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
11424 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
11425 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011426 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011427 Arguments :
11428 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11429 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11430 as explained at the top of this document.
11431
11432 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
11433 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
11434 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
11435 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
11436 data for at most the specified amount of time.
11437
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011438 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
11439 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
11440 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
11441 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
11442
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011443 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
11444 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011445 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011446 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010011447 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
11448 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
11449 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
11450 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011451
11452 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
11453 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
11454 it pass through unaffected.
11455
11456 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
11457 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
11458 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011459 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011460 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
11461 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020011462 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
11463 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
11464 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011465
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011466 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011467 "timeout client".
11468
11469
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011470tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11471 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
11472 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11473 no | no | yes | yes
11474 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011475 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11476 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011477
11478 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
11479
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011480 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011481 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
11482 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011483 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
11484 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011485
11486 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
11487
11488 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
11489 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
11490 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
11491 inserted.
11492
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011493 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011494 - accept :
11495 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11496 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11497 the rules evaluation.
11498
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011499 - close :
11500 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
11501 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
11502 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
11503 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
11504 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
11505 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011506 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011507 protocols.
11508
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011509 - reject :
11510 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11511 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011512 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011513
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011514 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
11515 Sets a variable.
11516
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011517 - unset-var(<var-name>)
11518 Unsets a variable.
11519
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011520 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
11521 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
11522 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
11523 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
11524
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011525 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
11526 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
11527 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
11528 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
11529
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011530 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
11531 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
11532 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
11533 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
11534 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011535
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011536 - "silent-drop" :
11537 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011538 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011539 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
11540 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
11541 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
11542 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
11543 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011544 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
11545 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011546 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
11547 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011548 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011549 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
11550 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
11551 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
11552 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
11553
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011554 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
11555 Send a group of SPOE messages.
11556
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011557 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11558 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11559 for changing the default action to a reject.
11560
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011561 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
11562 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
11563 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
11564 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011565 period.
11566
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011567 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
11568 declared inline.
11569
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011570 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
11571 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010011572 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011573 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11574 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011575 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011576 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011577 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011578 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
11579 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011580 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010011581 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
11582 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011583
11584 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11585 followed by some converters.
11586
11587 Example:
11588
11589 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
11590
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011591 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
11592 <var-name>.
11593
11594 Example:
11595
11596 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
11597
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011598 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
11599 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
11600 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
11601 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
11602 the SPOE agent name must be used.
11603
11604 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
11605
11606 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
11607
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011608 See section 7 about ACL usage.
11609
11610 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
11611
11612
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011613tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11614 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
11615 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11616 no | yes | yes | no
11617 Arguments :
11618 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11619 below.
11620
11621 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
11622
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011623 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011624 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
11625 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
11626 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
11627 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
11628 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
11629 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
11630 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011631 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011632 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
11633 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
11634 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
11635 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
11636 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
11637 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
11638 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
11639 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
11640 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
11641 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
11642 instead.
11643
11644 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
11645 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
11646 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
11647 rules which may be inserted.
11648
11649 Several types of actions are supported :
11650 - accept : the request is accepted
11651 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
11652 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
11653 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011654 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011655 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011656 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011657 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011658 - silent-drop
11659
11660 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
11661 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
11662 sections for a complete description.
11663
11664 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11665 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11666 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
11667
11668 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
11669 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
11670 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
11671 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
11672 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
11673
11674 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
11675 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
11676
11677 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
11678 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
11679 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
11680
11681 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
11682 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
11683 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
11684
11685 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
11686 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
11687 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
11688
11689 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
11690 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
11691 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
11692
11693 See section 7 about ACL usage.
11694
11695 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
11696
11697
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011698tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
11699 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
11700 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11701 no | no | yes | yes
11702 Arguments :
11703 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11704 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11705 as explained at the top of this document.
11706
11707 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
11708
11709
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011710timeout check <timeout>
11711 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
11712 established.
11713
11714 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11715 yes | no | yes | yes
11716 Arguments:
11717 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11718 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11719 as explained at the top of this document.
11720
11721 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
11722 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011723 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011724 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010011725 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
11726 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
11727 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011728
11729 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
11730 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
11731
11732 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
11733 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010011734 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011735
11736 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11737 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11738 forget about it.
11739
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010011740 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
11741 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011742
11743
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011744timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011745 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
11746 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11747 yes | yes | yes | no
11748 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011749 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011750 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11751 as explained at the top of this document.
11752
11753 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
11754 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
11755 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010011756 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
11757 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
11758 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
11759 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011760 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
11761 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
11762 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011763 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011764 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011765 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
11766 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011767 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
11768 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011769
11770 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
11771 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11772 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
11773 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011774 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011775 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
11776
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011777 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010011778
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011779 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011780
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011781
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011782timeout client-fin <timeout>
11783 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
11784 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11785 yes | yes | yes | no
11786 Arguments :
11787 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11788 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11789 as explained at the top of this document.
11790
11791 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
11792 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
11793 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
11794 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
11795 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
11796 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
11797 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010011798 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
11799 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
11800 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011801
11802 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
11803 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
11804 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
11805
11806 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
11807
11808
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011809timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011810 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
11811 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11812 yes | no | yes | yes
11813 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011814 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011815 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11816 as explained at the top of this document.
11817
11818 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011819 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011820 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011821 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011822 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
11823 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011824
11825 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11826 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11827 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
11828 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011829 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011830 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
11831
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011832 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011833
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011834
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011835timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
11836 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
11837 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11838 yes | yes | yes | yes
11839 Arguments :
11840 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11841 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11842 as explained at the top of this document.
11843
11844 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
11845 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
11846 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
11847 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
11848 once the request has started to present itself.
11849
11850 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
11851 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
11852 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
11853 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
11854 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
11855
11856 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
11857 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
11858 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
11859 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
11860
11861 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
11862 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011863 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011864 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
11865 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020011866 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011867
11868 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
11869 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
11870 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
11871 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
11872
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011873 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
11874 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010011875 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
11876
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011877 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
11878
11879
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011880timeout http-request <timeout>
11881 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
11882 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020011883 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011884 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011885 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011886 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11887 as explained at the top of this document.
11888
11889 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
11890 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
11891 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
11892 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
11893 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
11894 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
11895 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020011896 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
11897 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
11898 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
11899 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011900 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020011901 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
11902 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011903
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010011904 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
11905 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
11906 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
11907 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
11908 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011909 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011910
11911 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
11912 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011913 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011914 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
11915 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
11916
11917 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020011918 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
11919 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
11920 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011921
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020011922 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010011923 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011924
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011925
11926timeout queue <timeout>
11927 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
11928 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11929 yes | no | yes | yes
11930 Arguments :
11931 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11932 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11933 as explained at the top of this document.
11934
11935 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
11936 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
11937 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
11938 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
11939 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
11940
11941 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
11942 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
11943 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
11944 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
11945
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011946 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011947
11948
11949timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011950 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
11951 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11952 yes | no | yes | yes
11953 Arguments :
11954 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11955 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11956 as explained at the top of this document.
11957
11958 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
11959 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
11960 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
11961 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
11962 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
11963 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
11964 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
11965
11966 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11967 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11968 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
11969 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
11970 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011971 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011972 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011973 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
11974 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011975 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
11976 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011977
11978 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11979 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11980 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
11981 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011982 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011983 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
11984
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011985 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011986
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011987
11988timeout server-fin <timeout>
11989 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
11990 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11991 yes | no | yes | yes
11992 Arguments :
11993 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11994 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11995 as explained at the top of this document.
11996
11997 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
11998 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
11999 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12000 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12001 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
12002 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12003 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
12004 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
12005 situations, it should not be needed.
12006
12007 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12008 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12009 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
12010
12011 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
12012
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012013
12014timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010012015 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012016 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12017 yes | yes | yes | yes
12018 Arguments :
12019 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
12020 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12021 as explained at the top of this document.
12022
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020012023 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
12024 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
12025 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012026
12027 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12028 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12029 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
12030 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010012031 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012032
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012033 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012034
12035
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012036timeout tunnel <timeout>
12037 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
12038 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12039 yes | no | yes | yes
12040 Arguments :
12041 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12042 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12043 as explained at the top of this document.
12044
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012045 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012046 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
12047 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
12048 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012049 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
12050 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012051 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
12052 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
12053 specified.
12054
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012055 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
12056 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
12057 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
12058 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
12059 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
12060 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
12061 state.
12062
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012063 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12064 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12065 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
12066 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012067 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012068
12069 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12070 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12071 forget about it.
12072
12073 Example :
12074 defaults http
12075 option http-server-close
12076 timeout connect 5s
12077 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012078 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012079 timeout server 30s
12080 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
12081
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012082 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012083
12084
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012085transparent (deprecated)
12086 Enable client-side transparent proxying
12087 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010012088 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012089 Arguments : none
12090
12091 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
12092 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
12093 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
12094 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
12095 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
12096 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
12097 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
12098 appropriate server.
12099
12100 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
12101
12102 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
12103 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
12104
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012105 See also: "option transparent"
12106
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012107unique-id-format <string>
12108 Generate a unique ID for each request.
12109 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12110 yes | yes | yes | no
12111 Arguments :
12112 <string> is a log-format string.
12113
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012114 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
12115 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
12116 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
12117 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012118
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012119 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
12120 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
12121 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
12122 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
12123 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
12124 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
12125 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
12126 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012127
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012128 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
12129 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012130
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012131 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012132
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050012133 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012134
12135 will generate:
12136
12137 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
12138
12139 See also: "unique-id-header"
12140
12141unique-id-header <name>
12142 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
12143 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12144 yes | yes | yes | no
12145 Arguments :
12146 <name> is the name of the header.
12147
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012148 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
12149 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012150
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012151 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012152
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050012153 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012154 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
12155
12156 will generate:
12157
12158 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
12159
12160 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012161
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020012162use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012163 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012164 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12165 no | yes | yes | no
12166 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012167 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
12168 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012169
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020012170 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
12171 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012172
12173 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
12174 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
12175 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012176 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012177 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012178 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
12179 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012180
12181 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
12182 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
12183 assign the backend.
12184
12185 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
12186 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
12187 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
12188 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
12189 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
12190 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
12191
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020012192 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012193 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020012194 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
12195 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
12196 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
12197
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012198 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
12199 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
12200 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
12201 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
12202 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
12203 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
12204 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
12205 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
12206 cannot be forced from the request.
12207
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012208 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012209 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
12210 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
12211
12212 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
12213 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012214
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012215use-fcgi-app <name>
12216 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
12217 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12218 no | no | yes | yes
12219 Arguments :
12220 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
12221
12222 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012223
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012224use-server <server> if <condition>
12225use-server <server> unless <condition>
12226 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
12227 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12228 no | no | yes | yes
12229 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012230 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
12231 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012232
12233 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
12234
12235 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
12236 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
12237 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
12238
12239 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
12240 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
12241 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
12242 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
12243 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
12244 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
12245 matches will assign the server.
12246
12247 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
12248 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
12249 with the next rules until one matches.
12250
12251 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
12252 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
12253 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
12254 according to other persistence mechanisms.
12255
12256 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
12257 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
12258 stripped.
12259
12260 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
12261 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020012262 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field when using protocols with
12263 implicit TLS (also see "req_ssl_sni"). And if these servers have their weight
12264 set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012265
12266 Example :
12267 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
12268 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
12269 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
12270 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020012271 server mail 192.168.0.1:465 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012272 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000012273 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012274 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
12275 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
12276
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012277 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
12278 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
12279 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
12280 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050012281 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012282 and we fall back to load balancing.
12283
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012284 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012285
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012286
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100122875. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012288--------------------------
12289
12290The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
12291depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
12292settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
12293written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
12294described in this section.
12295
12296
122975.1. Bind options
12298-----------------
12299
12300The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
12301as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
12302no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
12303parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
12304while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
12305provided immediately after the setting name.
12306
12307The currently supported settings are the following ones.
12308
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012309accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
12310 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
12311 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
12312 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
12313 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
12314 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
12315 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
12316 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
12317 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
12318 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010012319 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
12320 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
12321 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012322
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012323accept-proxy
12324 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020012325 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
12326 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012327 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
12328 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
12329 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
12330 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012331 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012332 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
12333 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012334 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
12335 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012336
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020012337allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010012338 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010012339 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012340 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010012341 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
12342 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020012343
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012344alpn <protocols>
12345 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
12346 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
12347 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012348 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012349 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012350 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
12351 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
12352 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
12353 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
12354 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
12355 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
12356 preference, like below :
12357
12358 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012359
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012360backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010012361 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012362 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
12363
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010012364curves <curves>
12365 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
12366 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
12367 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
12368 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
12369 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
12370 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
12371
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020012372ecdhe <named curve>
12373 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010012374 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
12375 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020012376
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012377ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012378 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12379 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
12380 client's certificate.
12381
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012382ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
12383 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
12384 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
12385 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
12386 error is ignored.
12387
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012388ca-sign-file <cafile>
12389 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12390 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
12391 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
12392 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
12393 'generate-certificates' for details.
12394
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000012395ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012396 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
12397 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
12398 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
12399 'generate-certificates' for details.
12400
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010012401ca-verify-file <cafile>
12402 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
12403 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
12404 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
12405 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
12406 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
12407
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012408ciphers <ciphers>
12409 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
12410 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000012411 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012412 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012413 information and recommendations see e.g.
12414 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
12415 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
12416 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
12417
12418ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
12419 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
12420 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
12421 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
12422 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012423 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
12424 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012425
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012426crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012427 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12428 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
12429 to verify client's certificate.
12430
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012431crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012432 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12433 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
12434 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
12435 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
12436 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010012437 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
12438 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012439
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010012440 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
12441 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
12442
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012443 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
12444 are loaded.
12445
12446 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010012447 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
12448 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
12449 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
12450 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
12451 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
12452 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
12453 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010012454 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012455
12456 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
12457 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
12458 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
12459 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010012460 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
12461 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012462
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020012463 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012464
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012465 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012466 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012467 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
12468 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012469 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
12470 clients).
12471
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020012472 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
12473 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
12474 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
12475 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
12476 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
12477 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
12478 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
12479 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
12480 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
12481 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
12482 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
12483 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
12484 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
12485
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010012486 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
12487 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
12488 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
12489 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
12490 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
12491
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050012492 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
12493 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
12494 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
12495 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012496
12497 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
12498 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
12499 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
12500 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
12501 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
12502 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
12503 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
12504 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
12505 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
12506
12507 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
12508
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050012509 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012510 a cert bundle.
12511
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012512 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012513 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
12514 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
12515 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
12516 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
12517 provide multi-cert support.
12518
12519 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
12520
12521 Filename | CN | SAN
12522 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
12523 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050012524 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012525 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
12526 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
12527
12528 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
12529 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
12530 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
12531 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020012532 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
12533 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
12534 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012535
12536 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
12537 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
12538
12539 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
12540 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
12541 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
12542
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012543crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012544 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012545 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012546 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012547 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012548
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012549crt-list <file>
12550 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012551 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
12552 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012553
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012554 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
12555
William Lallemand5d036392020-06-30 16:11:36 +020012556 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
12557 "ciphers", "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names",
12558 "npn", "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
12559 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
12560 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012561
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020012562 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
12563 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
12564 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
12565 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
12566 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
12567 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
12568 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
12569 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012570
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050012571 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020012572 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020012573 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
12574 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
12575 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012576
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020012577 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
12578
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012579 crt-list file example:
12580 cert1.pem
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020012581 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010012582 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012583 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010012584 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012585
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012586defer-accept
12587 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
12588 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
12589 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012590 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012591 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
12592 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
12593 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
12594 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
12595 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
12596 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
12597 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
12598
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020012599expose-fd listeners
12600 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
12601 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020012602 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
12603 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012604 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020012605
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012606force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012607 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012608 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012609 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012610 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012611
12612force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012613 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012614 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012615 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012616
12617force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012618 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012619 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012620 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012621
12622force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012623 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012624 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012625 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012626
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012627force-tlsv13
12628 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
12629 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012630 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012631
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012632generate-certificates
12633 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12634 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
12635 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
12636 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
12637 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
12638 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
12639 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
12640 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
12641 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
12642 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
12643 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
12644
12645 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
12646 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012647 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012648 certificate is used many times.
12649
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012650gid <gid>
12651 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
12652 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12653 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
12654 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
12655 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12656
12657group <group>
12658 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
12659 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
12660 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
12661 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
12662 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12663
12664id <id>
12665 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
12666 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
12667 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
12668 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
12669
12670interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010012671 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
12672 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
12673 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
12674 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
12675 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
12676 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010012677 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
12678 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
12679 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
12680 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
12681 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
12682 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012683
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012684level <level>
12685 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
12686 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
12687 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012688 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012689 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
12690 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
12691 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012692 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012693 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012694 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012695 all counters).
12696
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020012697severity-output <format>
12698 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
12699 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
12700 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
12701 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
12702 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
12703 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
12704 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
12705 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
12706 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
12707 rfc5424 convention.
12708
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012709maxconn <maxconn>
12710 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
12711 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
12712 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
12713 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
12714 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
12715 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
12716 eat all memory.
12717
12718mode <mode>
12719 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
12720 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
12721 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
12722 UNIX sockets.
12723
12724mss <maxseg>
12725 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
12726 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
12727 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
12728 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
12729 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
12730 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
12731 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
12732 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
12733 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
12734 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
12735 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
12736
12737name <name>
12738 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
12739 page.
12740
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020012741namespace <name>
12742 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
12743 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
12744 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
12745 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
12746
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012747nice <nice>
12748 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
12749 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
12750 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
12751 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
12752 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
12753 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
12754 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
12755 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
12756 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
12757 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
12758 one for an RDP socket.
12759
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020012760no-ca-names
12761 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12762 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010012763 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020012764
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012765no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012766 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012767 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012768 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012769 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012770 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
12771 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012772
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020012773no-tls-tickets
12774 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12775 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
12776 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012777 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
12778 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010012779 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
12780 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
12781 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020012782
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012783no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012784 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012785 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012786 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012787 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012788 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12789 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012790
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012791no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012792 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012793 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012794 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012795 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012796 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12797 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012798
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012799no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012800 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012801 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012802 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012803 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012804 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12805 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012806
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012807no-tlsv13
12808 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12809 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
12810 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
12811 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012812 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12813 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012814
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020012815npn <protocols>
12816 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
12817 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
12818 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012819 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012820 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012821 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
12822 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
12823 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
12824 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
12825 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020012826
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000012827prefer-client-ciphers
12828 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
12829 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
12830 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020012831 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
12832 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
12833 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000012834
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012835process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010012836 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012837 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012838 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012839 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
12840 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
12841 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
12842 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012843 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010012844 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
12845 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
12846 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
12847 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
12848 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012849
12850 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
12851
12852 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
12853 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
12854 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
12855 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
12856 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
12857 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
12858 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
12859 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020012860
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020012861proto <name>
12862 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
12863 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
12864 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
12865 in haproxy -vv.
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040012866 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020012867 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080012868 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020012869 h2" on the bind line.
12870
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012871ssl
12872 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012873 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012874 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
12875 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020012876 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
12877 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012878
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012879ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12880 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020012881 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
12882 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
12883 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012884 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12885
12886ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020012887 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
12888 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
12889 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
12890 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012891
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010012892strict-sni
12893 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
12894 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
12895 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
12896 See the "crt" option for more information.
12897
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010012898tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012899 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010012900 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
12901 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012902 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010012903 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
12904 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
12905 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
12906 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
12907 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
12908 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
12909 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12910
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020012911tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010012912 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020012913 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
12914 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
12915 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
12916 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
12917 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
12918 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
12919 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020012920 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
12921 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
12922 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020012923
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010012924tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
12925 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010012926 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
12927 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
12928 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
12929 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
12930 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
12931 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
12932 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
12933 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
12934 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
12935 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010012936 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
12937 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
12938
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012939transparent
12940 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
12941 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
12942 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
12943 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
12944 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
12945 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
12946 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
12947 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
12948 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
12949 so check for support with your vendor.
12950
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012951v4v6
12952 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
12953 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
12954 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
12955 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012956 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012957
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010012958v6only
12959 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
12960 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
12961 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012962 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
12963 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010012964
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012965uid <uid>
12966 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
12967 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12968 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
12969 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
12970 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12971
12972user <user>
12973 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
12974 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12975 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
12976 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
12977 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12978
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012979verify [none|optional|required]
12980 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
12981 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
12982 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
12983 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
12984 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012985 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
12986 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
12987 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
12988 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012989
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200129905.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010012991------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012992
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010012993The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
12994which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
12995arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
12996settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
12997after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
12998Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
12999address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013000
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013001 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010013002 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013003
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013004Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
13005keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
13006
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013007The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013008
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013009addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013010 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010013011 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
13012 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
13013 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
13014 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
13015 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013016
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013017agent-check
13018 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013019 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010013020 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
13021 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
13022 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013023
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013024 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013025 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020013026 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
13027 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
13028 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013029
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013030 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
13031 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
13032 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
13033 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
13034 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020013035
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013036 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013037 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013038
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013039 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
13040 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
13041 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013042
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013043 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
13044 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
13045 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013046
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013047 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
13048 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
13049 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
13050 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
13051 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013052 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013053 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013054
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013055 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
13056 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013057
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013058 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
13059 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
13060 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
13061 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
13062 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
13063 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
13064 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
13065 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
13066 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013067
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090013068 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
13069 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013070 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
13071 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
13072 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010013073 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090013074
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013075 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013076 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013077
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070013078agent-send <string>
13079 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
13080 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
13081 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
13082 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
13083 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
13084
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013085agent-inter <delay>
13086 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
13087 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
13088
13089 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
13090 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
13091 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
13092 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
13093 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
13094 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
13095 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
13096 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
13097 of backends use the same servers.
13098
13099 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
13100
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010013101agent-addr <addr>
13102 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
13103
13104 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
13105 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
13106 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
13107 hostname, it will be resolved.
13108
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013109agent-port <port>
13110 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
13111
13112 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
13113
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020013114allow-0rtt
13115 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020013116 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
13117 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020013118
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013119alpn <protocols>
13120 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
13121 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
13122 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013123 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013124 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
13125 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
13126 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
13127 now obsolete NPN extension.
13128 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
13129 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
13130
13131 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
13132
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013133backup
13134 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
13135 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
13136 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
13137 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013138 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
13139 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013140
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013141ca-file <cafile>
13142 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13143 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
13144 server's certificate.
13145
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013146check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020013147 This option enables health checks on a server:
13148 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
13149 considered available.
13150 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
13151 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
13152 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
13153 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
13154 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
13155 set.
13156 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
13157 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
13158 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
13159 exchanges succeed.
13160
13161 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
13162 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
13163 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
13164 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
13165 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050013166 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020013167 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
13168
13169 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
13170 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
13171
13172 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
13173 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
13174
13175 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
13176 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
13177 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
13178 available.
13179
13180 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
13181 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
13182 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
13183
13184 Example:
13185 # simple tcp check
13186 backend foo
13187 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
13188 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
13189 backend foo
13190 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
13191 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
13192 backend foo
13193 option tcp-check
13194 tcp-check connect
13195 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013196
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020013197check-send-proxy
13198 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
13199 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
13200 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
13201 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
13202 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
13203 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
13204 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
13205
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010013206check-alpn <protocols>
13207 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
13208 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
13209 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
13210
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020013211check-proto <name>
13212 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
13213 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
13214 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
13215 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv.
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013216 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020013217 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
13218 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
13219
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010013220check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020013221 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010013222 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
13223 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020013224
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013225check-ssl
13226 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
13227 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
13228 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
13229 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013230 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013231 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
13232 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013233 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013234 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
13235 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013236
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013237check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013238 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013239 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
13240 for normal traffic.
13241
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013242ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013243 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
13244 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
13245 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013246 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
13247 information and recommendations see e.g.
13248 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
13249 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
13250 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013251
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013252ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
13253 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
13254 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
13255 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
13256 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013257 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
13258 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
13259 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013260
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013261cookie <value>
13262 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
13263 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
13264 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
13265 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
13266 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
13267 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
13268 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
13269
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013270crl-file <crlfile>
13271 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13272 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
13273 to verify server's certificate.
13274
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020013275crt <cert>
13276 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
13277 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
13278 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
13279 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
13280 certificate request.
13281
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013282disabled
13283 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
13284 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
13285 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
13286 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
13287 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013288 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013289
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013290enabled
13291 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
13292 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
13293 default value.
13294 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
13295 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013296
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013297error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010013298 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
13299 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
13300 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013301
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013302 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013303
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013304fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013305 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
13306 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
13307 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
13308
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013309force-sslv3
13310 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
13311 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013312 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013313 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013314
13315force-tlsv10
13316 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013317 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013318 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013319
13320force-tlsv11
13321 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013322 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013323 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013324
13325force-tlsv12
13326 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013327 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013328 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013329
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013330force-tlsv13
13331 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
13332 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013333 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013334
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013335id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020013336 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
13337 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
13338 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013339
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013340init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
13341 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
13342 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013343 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013344 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
13345 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
13346 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
13347 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
13348 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
13349 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
13350 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
13351 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
13352 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013353 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013354 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
13355 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
13356 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
13357 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
13358 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
13359 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013360 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013361
13362 Example:
13363 defaults
13364 # never fail on address resolution
13365 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
13366
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013367inter <delay>
13368fastinter <delay>
13369downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013370 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
13371 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
13372 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
13373 between checks depending on the server state :
13374
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020013375 Server state | Interval used
13376 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13377 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
13378 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13379 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
13380 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
13381 or yet unchecked. |
13382 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13383 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
13384 | "inter" otherwise.
13385 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013386
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013387 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
13388 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
13389 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
13390 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013391 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
13392 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
13393 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
13394 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
13395 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013396
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020013397log-proto <logproto>
13398 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
13399 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
13400 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
13401 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
13402
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013403maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013404 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
13405 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010013406 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
13407 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013408 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
13409 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
13410 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
13411 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
13412
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010013413 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
13414 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
13415 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
13416 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
13417 than 50 concurrent requests.
13418
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013419maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013420 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
13421 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
13422 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
13423 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
13424 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
13425 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
13426 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
13427
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010013428max-reuse <count>
13429 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
13430 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
13431 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
13432 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
13433 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
13434 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
13435 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
13436 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
13437
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013438minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013439 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
13440 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
13441 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
13442 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
13443 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
13444 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013445 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013446 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013447
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013448namespace <name>
13449 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13450 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
13451 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13452 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13453
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013454no-agent-check
13455 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
13456 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13457 default value.
13458 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13459 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
13460
13461no-backup
13462 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
13463 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13464 default value.
13465 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13466 "default-server" "backup" setting.
13467
13468no-check
13469 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
13470 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13471 default value.
13472 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13473 "default-server" "check" setting.
13474
13475no-check-ssl
13476 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
13477 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13478 default value.
13479 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13480 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
13481
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013482no-send-proxy
13483 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
13484 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13485 default value.
13486 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13487 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
13488
13489no-send-proxy-v2
13490 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
13491 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13492 default value.
13493 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13494 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
13495
13496no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
13497 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
13498 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13499 default value.
13500 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13501 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
13502
13503no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
13504 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
13505 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13506 default value.
13507 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13508 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
13509
13510no-ssl
13511 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
13512 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13513 default value.
13514 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13515 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
13516
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010013517no-ssl-reuse
13518 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
13519 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
13520 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
13521 and for paranoid users.
13522
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013523no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013524 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
13525 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013526 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013527
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013528 Supported in default-server: No
13529
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020013530no-tls-tickets
13531 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13532 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
13533 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013534 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
13535 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013536 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13537 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13538 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013539 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020013540
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013541no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013542 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013543 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13544 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013545 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13546 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013547 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013548
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013549 Supported in default-server: No
13550
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013551no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013552 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013553 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13554 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013555 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13556 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013557 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013558
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013559 Supported in default-server: No
13560
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013561no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013562 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013563 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13564 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013565 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13566 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013567 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013568
13569 Supported in default-server: No
13570
13571no-tlsv13
13572 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
13573 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13574 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
13575 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13576 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013577 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013578
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013579 Supported in default-server: No
13580
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013581no-verifyhost
13582 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
13583 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13584 default value.
13585 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13586 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013587
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020013588no-tfo
13589 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
13590 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13591 default value.
13592 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13593 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
13594
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090013595non-stick
13596 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
13597 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
13598 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
13599
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013600npn <protocols>
13601 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
13602 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
13603 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013604 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013605 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
13606 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
13607 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
13608
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013609observe <mode>
13610 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
13611 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
13612 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
13613 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
13614 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
13615 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010013616 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013617
13618 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
13619
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013620on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013621 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
13622 Currently, four modes are available:
13623 - fastinter: force fastinter
13624 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
13625 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
13626 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
13627 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
13628
13629 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
13630
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090013631on-marked-down <action>
13632 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
13633 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013634 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
13635 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
13636 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
13637 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
13638 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
13639 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
13640 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
13641 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090013642
13643 Actions are disabled by default
13644
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013645on-marked-up <action>
13646 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
13647 Currently one action is available:
13648 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
13649 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
13650 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
13651 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013652 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
13653 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013654 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
13655 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
13656
13657 Actions are disabled by default
13658
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020013659pool-low-conn <max>
13660 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
13661 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
13662 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
13663 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
13664 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
13665 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
13666 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
13667 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
13668 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
13669 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
13670 applying to "http-reuse".
13671
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010013672pool-max-conn <max>
13673 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
13674 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
13675 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
13676 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
13677 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
13678 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
13679
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010013680pool-purge-delay <delay>
13681 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010013682 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020013683 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010013684
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013685port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013686 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
13687 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
13688 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
13689 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
13690 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
13691 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
13692
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020013693proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020013694 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
13695 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
13696 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
13697 reported in haproxy -vv.
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013698 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020013699 protocol for all connections established to this server.
13700
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013701redir <prefix>
13702 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
13703 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
13704 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
13705 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
13706 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
13707 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
13708 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
13709 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013710 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013711 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013712 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
13713 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
13714 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
13715 loop between the client and HAProxy!
13716
13717 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
13718
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013719rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013720 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
13721 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
13722 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
13723
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020013724resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
13725 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
13726 server.
13727
13728 Available options:
13729
13730 * allow-dup-ip
13731 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
13732 resolution at runtime is in operation.
13733 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
13734 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
13735 For such case, simply enable this option.
13736 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
13737
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050013738 * ignore-weight
13739 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
13740 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
13741 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
13742
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020013743 * prevent-dup-ip
13744 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
13745 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
13746 same fqdn.
13747 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
13748
13749 Example:
13750 backend b_myapp
13751 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
13752 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
13753 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
13754
13755 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
13756 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
13757 it
13758 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
13759 different address
13760
13761 Default value: not set
13762
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013763resolve-prefer <family>
13764 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
13765 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
13766 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
13767 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
13768
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020013769 Default value: ipv6
13770
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013771 Example:
13772
13773 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013774
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013775resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013776 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013777 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013778 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013779 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
13780 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013781 configured network, another address is selected.
13782
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013783 Example:
13784
13785 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013786
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013787resolvers <id>
13788 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
13789 hostname.
13790
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013791 Example:
13792
13793 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013794
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013795 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013796
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010013797send-proxy
13798 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
13799 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
13800 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
13801 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013802 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
13803 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
13804 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
13805 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
13806 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
13807 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
13808 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
13809 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
13810 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
13811 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013812 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
13813 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010013814
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013815send-proxy-v2
13816 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
13817 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
13818 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
13819 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020013820 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
13821 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
13822 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
13823 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013824
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010013825proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010013826 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
13827 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
13828
13829 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
13830 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
13831 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
13832 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
13833 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
13834 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
13835 connection is supported).
13836 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
13837 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
13838 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
13839 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
13840 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
13841 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
13842 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010013843
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013844send-proxy-v2-ssl
13845 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
13846 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
13847 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
13848 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
13849 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
13850 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
13851 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013852 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
13853 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013854
13855send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
13856 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
13857 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
13858 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
13859 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
13860 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
13861 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
13862 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
13863 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013864 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
13865 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013866
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013867slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013868 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
13869 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
13870 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
13871 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
13872 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
13873 parameters :
13874
13875 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
13876 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
13877
13878 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
13879 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
13880 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
13881 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
13882
13883 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
13884 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
13885 seen as failed.
13886
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020013887sni <expression>
13888 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
13889 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
13890 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
13891 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020013892 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
13893 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020013894 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010013895 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
13896 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020013897
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020013898source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020013899source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020013900source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013901 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
13902 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
13903 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
13904 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
13905
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020013906 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
13907 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
13908 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
13909 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
13910 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
13911 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
13912 server.
13913
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000013914 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
13915 specifying the source address without port(s).
13916
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013917ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020013918 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
13919 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
13920 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
13921 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
13922 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
13923 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013924 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
13925 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013926
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013927ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13928 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
13929 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
13930 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
13931
13932ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13933 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
13934 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
13935 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
13936
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013937ssl-reuse
13938 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
13939 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13940 default value.
13941 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13942 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
13943
13944stick
13945 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
13946 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13947 default value.
13948 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13949 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013950
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013951socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013952 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013953 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
13954 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
13955
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020013956tcp-ut <delay>
13957 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
13958 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
13959 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013960 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020013961 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
13962 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
13963 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
13964 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
13965 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
13966 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
13967 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
13968 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
13969 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
13970
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010013971tfo
13972 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
13973 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
13974 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
13975 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
13976 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020013977 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010013978
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013979track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020013980 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
13981 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
13982 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
13983 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013984 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
13985
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013986tls-tickets
13987 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
13988 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13989 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013990 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13991 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13992 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013993 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010013994 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013995
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013996verify [none|required]
13997 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010013998 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020013999 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
14000 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014001 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014002 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
14003 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
14004 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
14005 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
14006 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
14007 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
14008 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
14009 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014010
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070014011verifyhost <hostname>
14012 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014013 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
14014 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
14015 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
14016 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
14017 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
14018 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
14019 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
14020 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070014021
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014022weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014023 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
14024 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
14025 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020014026 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
14027 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
14028 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
14029 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
14030 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
14031 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014032
14033
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200140345.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
14035-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014036
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014037HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
14038using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
14039configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014040This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
14041can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
14042workload.
14043This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
14044resolution at run time.
14045Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
14046carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
14047
14048
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200140495.3.1. Global overview
14050----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014051
14052As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
14053different steps of the process life:
14054
14055 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
14056 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
14057 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
14058
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014059 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
14060 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014061
14062A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
14063 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
14064 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
14065 resolution to know this new IP.
14066
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014067When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014068HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014069SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
14070from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
14071will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
14072will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020014073
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014074A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014075 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014076 first valid response.
14077
14078 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
14079 servers return an error.
14080
14081
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200140825.3.2. The resolvers section
14083----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014084
14085This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014086HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
14087contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014088
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014089When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
14090uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
14091is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
14092answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
14093
14094When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014095used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014096
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014097 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
14098 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
14099 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014100
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014101 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
14102 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014103
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014104 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
14105 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
14106 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014107
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014108For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
14109following scenarios are possible:
14110
14111 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
14112 ignored
14113
14114 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
14115 applied
14116
14117 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
14118 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
14119
14120 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
14121 retries the query with a new type
14122
14123 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
14124 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014125
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014126As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
14127a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014128<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014129
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014130
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014131resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014132 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014133
14134A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
14135
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020014136accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014137 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014138 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020014139 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
14140 by RFC 6891)
14141
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020014142 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
14143
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014144nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
14145 DNS server description:
14146 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
14147 <ip> : IP address of the server
14148 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
14149
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060014150parse-resolv-conf
14151 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
14152 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
14153 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
14154
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014155hold <status> <period>
14156 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
14157 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010014158 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014159 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014160 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
14161 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
14162 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
14163
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020014164 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014165
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014166resolve_retries <nb>
14167 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
14168 giving up.
14169 Default value: 3
14170
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014171 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
14172 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
14173 type.
14174
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014175timeout <event> <time>
14176 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
14177 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
14178 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014179 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
14180 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014181 Default value: 1s
14182 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014183 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014184 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014185 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
14186 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
14187
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014188 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014189
14190 resolvers mydns
14191 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
14192 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060014193 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014194 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014195 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014196 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010014197 hold other 30s
14198 hold refused 30s
14199 hold nx 30s
14200 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014201 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014202 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014203
14204
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200142056. Cache
14206---------
14207
14208HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
14209(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
14210RAM.
14211
14212The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
14213this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
14214
14215If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
14216independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
14217when we try to allocate a new one.
14218
14219The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
14220
14221It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
14222"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
14223for more details.
14224
14225When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
14226replaced by "<CACHE>".
14227
14228
142296.1. Limitation
14230----------------
14231
14232The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
14233
14234- If the response is not a 200
14235- If the response contains a Vary header
14236- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
14237- If the response is not cacheable
14238
14239- If the request is not a GET
14240- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
14241- If the request contains an Authorization header
14242
14243
142446.2. Setup
14245-----------
14246
14247To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
14248the corresponding http-request and response actions.
14249
14250
142516.2.1. Cache section
14252---------------------
14253
14254cache <name>
14255 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
14256 size of cache is mandatory.
14257
14258total-max-size <megabytes>
14259 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
14260 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
14261
14262max-object-size <bytes>
14263 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
14264 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
14265 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
14266
14267max-age <seconds>
14268 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
14269 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
14270 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
14271 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
14272 default.
14273
14274
142756.2.2. Proxy section
14276---------------------
14277
14278http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14279 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
14280 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
14281 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
14282 after this one.
14283
14284http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14285 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
14286 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
14287 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
14288 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
14289
14290
14291Example:
14292
14293 backend bck1
14294 mode http
14295
14296 http-request cache-use foobar
14297 http-response cache-store foobar
14298 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
14299
14300 cache foobar
14301 total-max-size 4
14302 max-age 240
14303
14304
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200143057. Using ACLs and fetching samples
14306----------------------------------
14307
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014308HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014309client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
14310The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
14311these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
14312but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
14313data called patterns.
14314
14315
143167.1. ACL basics
14317---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014318
14319The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
14320content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
14321from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
14322simple :
14323
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014324 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014325 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014326 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
14327 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014328
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014329The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
14330adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014331
14332In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
14333
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014334 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014335
14336This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
14337Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
14338and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014339an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
14340conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
14341as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
14342are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014343
14344ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
14345'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
14346which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
14347
14348There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
14349performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
14350
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014351The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
14352specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
14353this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014354methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
14355ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014356
14357Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
14358 - boolean
14359 - integer (signed or unsigned)
14360 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
14361 - string
14362 - data block
14363
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014364Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
14365converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
14366would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
14367The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
14368which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
14369
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014370Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
14371keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
14372fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
14373which are summarized in the table below :
14374
14375 +---------------------+-----------------+
14376 | Sample or converter | Default |
14377 | output type | matching method |
14378 +---------------------+-----------------+
14379 | boolean | bool |
14380 +---------------------+-----------------+
14381 | integer | int |
14382 +---------------------+-----------------+
14383 | ip | ip |
14384 +---------------------+-----------------+
14385 | string | str |
14386 +---------------------+-----------------+
14387 | binary | none, use "-m" |
14388 +---------------------+-----------------+
14389
14390Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
14391matching method, see below.
14392
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014393The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
14394 - boolean
14395 - integer or integer range
14396 - IP address / network
14397 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
14398 - regular expression
14399 - hex block
14400
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014401The following ACL flags are currently supported :
14402
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014403 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
14404 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014405 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014406 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010014407 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010014408 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014409 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
14410
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014411The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
14412read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
14413if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
14414lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
14415will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
14416beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
14417a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
14418lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
14419exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
14420
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010014421The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
14422parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
14423ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
14424a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
14425check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
14426
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010014427The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
14428socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
14429file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
14430
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014431Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
14432loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
14433
14434 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
14435
14436In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
14437the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
14438case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
14439as well.
14440
14441The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
14442sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
14443do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
14444methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
14445is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014446obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014447followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
14448default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
14449that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
14450string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
14451
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014452The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
14453By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
14454string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
14455resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
14456server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014457waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014458flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
14459function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
14460
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014461There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
14462sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
14463be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014464
14465 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
14466 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014467 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
14468 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
14469 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
14470 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014471
14472 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
14473 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014474 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014475
14476 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014477 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014478
14479 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014480 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014481
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014482 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014483 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
14484
14485 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
14486 binary or string samples.
14487
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014488 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
14489 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014490
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014491 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
14492 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
14493 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014494
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014495 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
14496 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014497
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014498 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
14499 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014500
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014501 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
14502 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014503
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014504 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
14505 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014506 This may be used with binary or string samples.
14507
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014508 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
14509 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
14510 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014511
14512For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
14513request, it is possible to do :
14514
14515 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
14516
14517In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
14518buffer, one would use the following acl :
14519
14520 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
14521
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014522On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
14523possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
14524
14525 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
14526
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014527All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
14528criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
14529method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
14530to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
14531criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
14532the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014533
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014534If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014535the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
14536For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014537
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014538 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
14539 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
14540 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
14541 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014542
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014543
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014544The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
14545types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
14546combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
14547brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
14548default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014549
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014550 +-------------------------------------------------+
14551 | Input sample type |
14552 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014553 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014554 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
14555 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
14556 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014557 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014558 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014559 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014560 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014561 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014562 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014563 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014564 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014565 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014566 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014567 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014568 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014569 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014570 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014571 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014572 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014573 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014574 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014575 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014576 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014577 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014578 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
14579 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
14580 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014581
14582
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200145837.1.1. Matching booleans
14584------------------------
14585
14586In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
14587Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
14588When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
14589that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
14590
14591Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
14592return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
14593"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
14594
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014595
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200145967.1.2. Matching integers
14597------------------------
14598
14599Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
14600enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
14601to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
14602
14603Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
14604matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
14605lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014606
14607For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
14608unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
14609representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
14610
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014611As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
14612two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
14613instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
14614ranges and operators.
14615
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014616For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014617operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
14618Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
14619of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014620
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014621Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014622
14623 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
14624 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
14625 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
14626 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
14627 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
14628
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014629For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014630
14631 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
14632
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014633This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
14634
14635 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
14636
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014637
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200146387.1.3. Matching strings
14639-----------------------
14640
14641String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
14642different forms :
14643
14644 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014645 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014646
14647 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014648 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014649
14650 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
14651 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
14652
14653 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
14654 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
14655
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010014656 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014657 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
14658 matches.
14659
14660 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
14661 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
14662 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014663
14664String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
14665exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
14666characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
14667string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
14668to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014669before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014670
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010014671Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
14672(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
14673Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
14674
14675Example:
14676 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
14677 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
14678
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014679
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200146807.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
14681---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014682
14683Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
14684they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
14685possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
14686passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
14687the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014688the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
14689match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014690
14691
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200146927.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
14693-------------------------------------
14694
14695It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
14696not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
14697a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
14698to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
14699digits may be used upper or lower case.
14700
14701Example :
14702 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
14703 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
14704
14705
147067.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
14707---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014708
14709IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
14710netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
14711within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010014712host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014713difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
14714at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
14715does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
14716parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014717
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020014718The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
14719abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
14720
14721 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
14722 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
14723 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
14724 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
14725 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
14726 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
14727 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
14728 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
14729
14730Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
14731192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
14732
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020014733IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
14734Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
14735trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
14736IPv6 patterns.
14737
14738HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
14739following situations :
14740 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
14741 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
14742 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
14743 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
14744 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
14745 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
14746 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
14747 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
14748 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
14749 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
14750
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014751
147527.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
14753----------------------------------
14754
14755Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
14756combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
14757
14758 - AND (implicit)
14759 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
14760 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014761
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014762A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014763
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014764 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020014765
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014766Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
14767indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020014768
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014769For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
14770"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
14771requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
14772is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
14773
14774 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014775 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
14776 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
14777 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014778
14779To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
14780and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
14781
14782 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
14783 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
14784 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
14785 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
14786
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014787 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014788 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
14789 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
14790 use_backend www if host_www
14791
14792It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
14793expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
14794be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
14795the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
14796
14797 The following rule :
14798
14799 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014800 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014801
14802 Can also be written that way :
14803
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014804 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014805
14806It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
14807to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
14808simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
14809sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
14810good use is the following :
14811
14812 With named ACLs :
14813
14814 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
14815 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
14816 monitor fail if site_dead
14817
14818 With anonymous ACLs :
14819
14820 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
14821
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014822See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
14823keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014824
14825
148267.3. Fetching samples
14827---------------------
14828
14829Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
14830against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
14831sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
14832ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
14833of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
14834available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
14835
14836This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
14837Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
14838compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
14839deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
14840
14841The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
14842matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
14843method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
14844indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
14845
14846As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
14847when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
14848mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
14849the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
14850ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
14851
14852Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
14853multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
14854when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014855incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
14856are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014857is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
14858all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
14859
14860Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
14861 - name
14862 - name(arg1)
14863 - name(arg1,arg2)
14864
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014865
148667.3.1. Converters
14867-----------------
14868
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014869Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
14870of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
14871is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
14872was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014873has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014874unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
14875
14876These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
14877sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
14878the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014879support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014880
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014881A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
14882support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
14883supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
14884(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
14885bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
14886
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014887The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014888
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001488951d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
14890 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
14891 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
14892 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
14893 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
14894 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
14895
14896 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014897 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
14898 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000014899 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
14900 frontend http-in
14901 bind *:8081
14902 default_backend servers
14903 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
14904 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
14905
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014906add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014907 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014908 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014909 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
14910 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014911 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014912 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14913 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14914 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14915 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014916 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014917 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014918
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010014919aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
14920 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
14921 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
14922 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
14923 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
14924 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
14925 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
14926
14927 Example:
14928 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
14929 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
14930
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014931and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014932 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014933 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014934 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
14935 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014936 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014937 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14938 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14939 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14940 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014941 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014942 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014943
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020014944b64dec
14945 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
14946 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
14947
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020014948base64
14949 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014950 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020014951 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
14952
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014953bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014954 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014955 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014956 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014957 presence of a flag).
14958
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010014959bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
14960 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
14961 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014962 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010014963
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010014964concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
14965 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
14966 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
14967 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
14968 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
14969 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
14970 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
14971 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
14972 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
14973 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
14974 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010014975 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014976 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010014977 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
14978 level parser. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010014979
14980 Example:
14981 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
14982 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
14983 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010014984 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010014985 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
14986
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014987cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014988 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
14989 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014990
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010014991crc32([<avalanche>])
14992 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
14993 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14994 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14995 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14996 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14997 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
14998 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
14999 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
15000 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
15001 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015002 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
15003
15004crc32c([<avalanche>])
15005 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
15006 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15007 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15008 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
15009 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
15010 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
15011 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
15012 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010015013
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020015014cut_crlf
15015 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
15016 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
15017 updated.
15018
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010015019da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015020 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
15021 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
15022 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
15023 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000015024 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015025 configuration language.
15026
15027 Example:
15028 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020015029 bind *:8881
15030 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000015031 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015032
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010015033debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
15034 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
15035 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
15036 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
15037 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
15038 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
15039 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
15040 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
15041 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
15042 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
15043 printable sample types.
15044
15045 Example:
15046 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020015047
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020015048digest(<algorithm>)
15049 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
15050 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
15051
15052 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15053 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15054
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015055div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015056 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
15057 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015058 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015059 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
15060 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015061 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015062 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15063 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15064 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15065 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015066 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015067 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015068
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015069djb2([<avalanche>])
15070 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
15071 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15072 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15073 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15074 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15075 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
15076 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015077 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
15078 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015079
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015080even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015081 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015082 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
15083
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020015084field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
15085 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
15086 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
15087 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
15088 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
15089 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
15090 fields.
15091
15092 Example :
15093 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
15094 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
15095 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
15096 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
15097 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010015098
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015099hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015100 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015101 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015102 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015103 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010015104
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020015105hex2i
15106 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015107 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020015108
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020015109htonl
15110 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
15111 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
15112 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
15113 unsigned 32-bit integer.
15114
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020015115hmac(<algorithm>, <key>)
15116 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
15117 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
15118 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
15119 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
15120
15121 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15122 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15123
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010015124http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015125 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
15126 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000015127 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
15128 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
15129 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
15130 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
15131 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
15132 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
15133 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
15134 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015135
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015136in_table(<table>)
15137 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15138 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
15139 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015140 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015141 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
15142
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010015143ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
15144 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015145 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010015146 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
15147 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
15148 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
15149 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
15150 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015151
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015152json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015153 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015154 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020015155 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015156 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
15157 of errors:
15158 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
15159 bytes, ...)
15160 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
15161 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
15162
15163 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
15164 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
15165 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
15166 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
15167 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
15168 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015169 - "ascii" : never fails;
15170 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
15171 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015172 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015173 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015174 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
15175 characters corresponding to the other errors.
15176
15177 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015178 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015179
15180 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015181 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020015182 capture request header user-agent len 150
15183 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015184
15185 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
15186 GET / HTTP/1.0
15187 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
15188
15189 Output log:
15190 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
15191
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015192language(<value>[,<default>])
15193 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
15194 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
15195 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
15196 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
15197 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
15198 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
15199 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
15200 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
15201 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015202 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015203 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
15204 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015205
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015206 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015207
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015208 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
15209 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015210
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015211 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
15212 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
15213 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
15214 use_backend spanish if es
15215 use_backend french if fr
15216 use_backend english if en
15217 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015218
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010015219length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010015220 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
15221 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
15222 type. The result is of type integer.
15223
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015224lower
15225 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
15226 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
15227 type. The result is of type string.
15228
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015229ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
15230 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
15231 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
15232 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
15233 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
15234 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
15235 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
15236
15237 Example :
15238
15239 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015240 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015241 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
15242
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020015243ltrim(<chars>)
15244 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
15245 representation of the input sample.
15246
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015247map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
15248map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
15249map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
15250 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
15251 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
15252 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
15253 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
15254 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
15255 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
15256 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
15257 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015258
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015259 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
15260 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
15261 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015262
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015263 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015264 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015265
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015266 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
15267 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15268 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
15269 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020015270 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
15271 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015272 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
15273 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15274 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
15275 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15276 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
15277 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15278 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
15279 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080015280 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
15281 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15282 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015283 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15284 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
15285 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15286 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
15287 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015288
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010015289 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
15290 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
15291 the corresponding match text.
15292
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015293 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
15294 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
15295 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
15296 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
15297 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015298
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015299 Example :
15300
15301 # this is a comment and is ignored
15302 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
15303 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
15304 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
15305 | | | `---------- value
15306 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
15307 | `---------------------------- key
15308 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
15309
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015310mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015311 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
15312 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015313 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015314 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015315 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015316 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15317 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15318 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15319 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015320 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015321 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015322
15323mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015324 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020015325 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
15326 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015327 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015328 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015329 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015330 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15331 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15332 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15333 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015334 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015335 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015336
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010015337nbsrv
15338 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
15339 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
15340 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
15341 map lookup.
15342
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015343neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015344 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
15345 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
15346 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
15347 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015348
15349not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015350 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015351 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015352 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015353 absence of a flag).
15354
15355odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015356 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015357 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
15358
15359or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015360 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015361 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015362 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
15363 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015364 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015365 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15366 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15367 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15368 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015369 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015370 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015371
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015372protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
15373 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
15374 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
15375 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
15376 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
15377 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
15378 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
15379 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
15380 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
15381 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
15382 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
15383 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
15384
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010015385regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015386 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
15387 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
15388 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
15389 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
15390 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
15391 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
15392 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
15393 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
15394 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015395 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
15396 of characters with other ones.
15397
15398 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
15399 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
15400 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
15401 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
15402 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
15403 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015404
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010015405 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015406
15407 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
15408 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
15409 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015410 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015411
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010015412 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
15413 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
15414
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010015415 # capture groups and backreferences
15416 # both lines do the same.
15417 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)]'
15418 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
15419
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015420capture-req(<id>)
15421 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
15422 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
15423
15424 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020015425 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
15426 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015427
15428capture-res(<id>)
15429 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
15430 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
15431
15432 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020015433 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
15434 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015435
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020015436rtrim(<chars>)
15437 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
15438 of the input sample.
15439
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015440sdbm([<avalanche>])
15441 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
15442 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15443 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15444 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15445 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15446 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
15447 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015448 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
15449 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015450
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020015451secure_memcmp(<var>)
15452 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
15453 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
15454 match.
15455
15456 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
15457 performed in constant time.
15458
15459 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15460 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15461
15462 Example :
15463
15464 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
15465 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
15466 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
15467 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
15468
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015469set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015470 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
15471 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
15472 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015473 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015474 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15475 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015476 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015477 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15478 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015479 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015480 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015481
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020015482sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020015483 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020015484 sample with length of 20 bytes.
15485
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020015486sha2([<bits>])
15487 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
15488 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
15489
15490 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
15491 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
15492
15493 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15494 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15495
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020015496srv_queue
15497 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
15498 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
15499 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
15500 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
15501 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
15502
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020015503strcmp(<var>)
15504 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
15505 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
15506 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
15507 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
15508 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
15509 shorter).
15510
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020015511 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
15512 strings in constant time.
15513
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020015514 Example :
15515
15516 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
15517 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
15518 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
15519
15520
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015521sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015522 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
15523 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015524 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015525 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
15526 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015527 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015528 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15529 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015530 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015531 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15532 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015533 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015534 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015535
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015536table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
15537 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15538 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15539 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
15540 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
15541 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
15542 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
15543
15544
15545table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
15546 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15547 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15548 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
15549 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
15550 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
15551 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
15552
15553table_conn_cnt(<table>)
15554 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15555 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015556 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015557 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
15558 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
15559
15560table_conn_cur(<table>)
15561 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15562 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15563 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
15564 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
15565 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
15566
15567table_conn_rate(<table>)
15568 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15569 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15570 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
15571 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
15572 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
15573
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015574table_gpt0(<table>)
15575 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15576 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
15577 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
15578 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
15579 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
15580
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015581table_gpc0(<table>)
15582 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15583 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15584 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
15585 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
15586 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
15587
15588table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
15589 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15590 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15591 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
15592 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
15593 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
15594 sample fetch keyword.
15595
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015596table_gpc1(<table>)
15597 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15598 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15599 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
15600 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
15601 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
15602
15603table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
15604 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15605 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15606 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
15607 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
15608 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
15609 sample fetch keyword.
15610
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015611table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
15612 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15613 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015614 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015615 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
15616 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
15617
15618table_http_err_rate(<table>)
15619 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15620 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15621 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
15622 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
15623 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
15624 keyword.
15625
15626table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
15627 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15628 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015629 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015630 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
15631 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
15632
15633table_http_req_rate(<table>)
15634 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15635 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15636 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
15637 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
15638 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
15639 keyword.
15640
15641table_kbytes_in(<table>)
15642 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15643 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015644 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015645 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
15646 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
15647 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
15648 keyword.
15649
15650table_kbytes_out(<table>)
15651 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15652 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015653 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015654 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
15655 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
15656 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
15657 keyword.
15658
15659table_server_id(<table>)
15660 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15661 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15662 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
15663 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
15664 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
15665 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
15666
15667table_sess_cnt(<table>)
15668 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15669 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015670 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015671 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
15672 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
15673 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
15674 keyword.
15675
15676table_sess_rate(<table>)
15677 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15678 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15679 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
15680 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
15681 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
15682 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
15683 keyword.
15684
15685table_trackers(<table>)
15686 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15687 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15688 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
15689 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
15690 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
15691 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
15692 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
15693 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
15694 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
15695 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
15696
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015697upper
15698 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
15699 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
15700 type. The result is of type string.
15701
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020015702url_dec([<in_form>])
15703 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
15704 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
15705 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
15706 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
15707 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
15708 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020015709
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015710ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010015711 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015712 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
15713 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
15714 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015715 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
15716 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
15717 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
15718 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015719 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015720 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
15721 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010015722
15723 Example:
15724 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
15725 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
15726
15727 message Point {
15728 int32 latitude = 1;
15729 int32 longitude = 2;
15730 }
15731
15732 message PPoint {
15733 Point point = 59;
15734 }
15735
15736 message Rectangle {
15737 // One corner of the rectangle.
15738 PPoint lo = 48;
15739 // The other corner of the rectangle.
15740 PPoint hi = 49;
15741 }
15742
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020015743 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
15744 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
15745 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010015746
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015747 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
15748 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015749 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015750 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
15751
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020015752 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015753
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015754 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015755
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020015756 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
15757 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
15758 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015759
15760 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
15761 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
15762 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
15763
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020015764 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
15765 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
15766 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015767
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010015768
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010015769unset-var(<var name>)
15770 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
15771 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
15772 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
15773 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15774 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
15775 response),
15776 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15777 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
15778 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
15779 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
15780
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015781utime(<format>[,<offset>])
15782 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
15783 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
15784 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
15785 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
15786 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
15787 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
15788
15789 Example :
15790
15791 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015792 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015793 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
15794
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020015795word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
15796 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
15797 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
15798 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010015799 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020015800 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
15801 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
15802
15803 Example :
15804 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
15805 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
15806 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
15807 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
15808 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010015809 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010015810
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015811wt6([<avalanche>])
15812 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
15813 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15814 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15815 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15816 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15817 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
15818 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015819 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
15820 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015821
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015822xor(<value>)
15823 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015824 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015825 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015826 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015827 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015828 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15829 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015830 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015831 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15832 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015833 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015834 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015835
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010015836xxh32([<seed>])
15837 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
15838 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
15839 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
15840 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
15841 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
15842 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
15843 as cryptographically secure.
15844
15845xxh64([<seed>])
15846 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
15847 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
15848 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
15849 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
15850 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
15851 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
15852 as cryptographically secure.
15853
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015854
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200158557.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015856--------------------------------------------
15857
15858A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
15859not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
15860"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
15861The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
15862
15863always_false : boolean
15864 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
15865 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
15866
15867always_true : boolean
15868 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
15869 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
15870
15871avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015872 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015873 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
15874 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
15875 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
15876 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
15877 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
15878 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
15879 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
15880 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
15881 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
15882 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
15883 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
15884 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
15885 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010015886
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015887be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020015888 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
15889 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
15890 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
15891 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040015892 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
15893
15894be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
15895 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
15896 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
15897 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
15898 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
15899 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040015900 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
15901 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040015902
15903 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
15904 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
15905 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015906
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015907be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
15908 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
15909 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
15910 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015911 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015912 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
15913 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015914
15915 Example :
15916 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
15917 backend dynamic
15918 mode http
15919 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
15920 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015921
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015922bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015923 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
15924 of the string.
15925
15926bool(<bool>) : bool
15927 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
15928 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
15929
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015930connslots([<backend>]) : integer
15931 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015932 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015933 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
15934 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050015935
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015936 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015937 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015938 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
15939
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015940 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
15941 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015942
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020015943 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015944 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015945 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015946 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015947 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015948 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020015949 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015950
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015951 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
15952 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015953 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015954 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015955
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010015956cpu_calls : integer
15957 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
15958 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
15959 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
15960 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
15961 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
15962 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
15963
15964cpu_ns_avg : integer
15965 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
15966 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
15967 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
15968 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
15969 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
15970 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
15971 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
15972 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
15973 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
15974 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
15975 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
15976
15977cpu_ns_tot : integer
15978 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
15979 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
15980 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
15981 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
15982 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
15983 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
15984 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
15985 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
15986 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
15987 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
15988 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
15989 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
15990 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
15991
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010015992date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020015993 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000015994
15995 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
15996 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
15997 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020015998 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
15999
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016000 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
16001 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
16002 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
16003 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
16004 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
16005
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020016006 Example :
16007
16008 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
16009 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020016010
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016011 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
16012 # millisecond granularity
16013 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
16014
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010016015date_us : integer
16016 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
16017 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
16018 from the same timeval structure.
16019
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020016020distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
16021 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
16022 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
16023 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
16024 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
16025 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
16026 list of supported tokens.
16027
16028distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
16029 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
16030 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
16031 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
16032 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
16033 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
16034 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
16035 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
16036 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
16037 supported tokens.
16038
16039 Example :
16040 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
16041 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
16042 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
16043 # send large files to the big farm
16044 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
16045
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020016046env(<name>) : string
16047 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
16048 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
16049 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
16050 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
16051 certain way.
16052
16053 Examples :
16054 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
16055 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
16056
16057 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
16058 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
16059
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016060fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
16061 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016062 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
16063 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016064 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
16065 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016066 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016067 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
16068 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020016069
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020016070fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
16071 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
16072 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
16073 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
16074
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016075fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
16076 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
16077 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
16078 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
16079 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
16080 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
16081 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
16082 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
16083 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010016084
16085 Example :
16086 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
16087 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
16088 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
16089 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
16090 frontend mail
16091 bind :25
16092 mode tcp
16093 maxconn 100
16094 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
16095 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
16096 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
16097 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016098
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010016099hostname : string
16100 Returns the system hostname.
16101
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016102int(<integer>) : signed integer
16103 Returns a signed integer.
16104
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016105ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
16106 Returns an ipv4.
16107
16108ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
16109 Returns an ipv6.
16110
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016111lat_ns_avg : integer
16112 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
16113 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
16114 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
16115 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
16116 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
16117 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
16118 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
16119 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
16120 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020016121 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
16122 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
16123 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
16124 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
16125 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
16126 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016127
16128lat_ns_tot : integer
16129 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
16130 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
16131 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
16132 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
16133 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
16134 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
16135 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
16136 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
16137 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020016138 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
16139 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
16140 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
16141 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
16142 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016143 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
16144 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
16145 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
16146 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
16147 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
16148 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
16149
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016150meth(<method>) : method
16151 Returns a method.
16152
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010016153nbproc : integer
16154 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
16155 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
16156 and debugging purposes.
16157
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016158nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
16159 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
16160 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
16161 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016162 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
16163 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
16164 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010016165
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040016166prio_class : integer
16167 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
16168 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
16169 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
16170
16171prio_offset : integer
16172 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
16173 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
16174 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
16175 set-priority-offset".
16176
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010016177proc : integer
16178 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
16179 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
16180 debugging purposes.
16181
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016182queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016183 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
16184 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
16185 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016186 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
16187 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
16188 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
16189 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
16190 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
16191
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010016192rand([<range>]) : integer
16193 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
16194 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
16195 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
16196 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
16197 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
16198
Luca Schimweg8a694b82019-09-10 15:42:52 +020016199uuid([<version>]) : string
16200 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
16201 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
16202 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
16203
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016204srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16205 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
16206 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
16207 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
16208 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
16209 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040016210 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
16211 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
16212
16213srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16214 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
16215 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
16216 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
16217 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
16218 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
16219 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
16220 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
16221
16222 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
16223 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016224
16225srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
16226 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
16227 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
16228 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016229 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016230 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
16231 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
16232 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
16233
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020016234srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16235 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
16236 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
16237 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
16238 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
16239 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
16240 fetch methods.
16241
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016242srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16243 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
16244 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016245 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016246 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
16247 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016248 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016249 overloading servers).
16250
16251 Example :
16252 # Redirect to a separate back
16253 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
16254 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
16255 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
16256
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020016257srv_iweight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
16258 Returns an integer corresponding to the server's initial weight. If <backend>
16259 is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. See also
16260 "srv_weight" and "srv_uweight".
16261
16262srv_uweight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
16263 Returns an integer corresponding to the user visible server's weight. If
16264 <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
16265 backend. See also "srv_weight" and "srv_iweight".
16266
16267srv_weight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
16268 Returns an integer corresponding to the current (or effective) server's
16269 weight. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
16270 backend. See also "srv_iweight" and "srv_uweight".
16271
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010016272stopping : boolean
16273 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
16274 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
16275 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
16276
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016277str(<string>) : string
16278 Returns a string.
16279
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016280table_avl([<table>]) : integer
16281 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
16282 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
16283
16284table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16285 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
16286 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
16287 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
16288
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010016289thread : integer
16290 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
16291 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
16292 and debugging purposes.
16293
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016294var(<var-name>) : undefined
16295 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016296 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
16297 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016298 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016299 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16300 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016301 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016302 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16303 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016304 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016305 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016306
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200163077.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016308----------------------------------
16309
16310The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
16311closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
16312methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
16313sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
16314TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016315the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
16316counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020016317"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
16318used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
16319can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
16320Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
16321table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
16322tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
16323currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016324
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010016325bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010016326 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
16327 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
16328 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
16329
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016330be_id : integer
16331 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016332 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
16333 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016334
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010016335be_name : string
16336 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016337 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
16338 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010016339
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016340dst : ip
16341 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
16342 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
16343 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
16344 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010016345 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
16346 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
16347 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
16348 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
16349 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
16350 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016351
16352dst_conn : integer
16353 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
16354 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
16355 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
16356 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
16357 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
16358 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
16359 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
16360 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016361
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016362dst_is_local : boolean
16363 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
16364 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
16365 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
16366 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016367 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016368 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
16369 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
16370 it only once per connection.
16371
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016372dst_port : integer
16373 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
16374 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
16375 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
16376 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
16377 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
16378 an HTTP header.
16379
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020016380fc_http_major : integer
16381 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
16382 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
16383 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
16384
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020016385fc_pp_authority : string
16386 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
16387 if any.
16388
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010016389fc_pp_unique_id : string
16390 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
16391 if any.
16392
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010016393fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
16394 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
16395 header.
16396
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020016397fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
16398 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
16399 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
16400 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
16401 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
16402 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
16403 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16404
16405fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
16406 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
16407 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
16408 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
16409 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
16410 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
16411 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16412
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016413fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016414 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
16415 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
16416 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
16417 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16418
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016419fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016420 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
16421 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
16422 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
16423 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16424
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016425fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016426 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
16427 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16428 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16429 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16430
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016431fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016432 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
16433 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16434 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16435 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16436
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016437fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016438 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
16439 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16440 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16441 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16442
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016443fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016444 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
16445 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16446 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16447 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16448
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020016449fe_defbe : string
16450 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
16451 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
16452
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016453fe_id : integer
16454 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010016455 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016456 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
16457
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010016458fe_name : string
16459 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
16460 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
16461 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
16462
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016463sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016464sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
16465sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
16466sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016467 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
16468 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
16469 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
16470
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016471sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016472sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
16473sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
16474sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016475 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
16476 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
16477 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
16478
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016479sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016480sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16481sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16482sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016483 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
16484 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016485 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
16486 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
16487 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016488
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016489 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016490 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
16491 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016492 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
16493 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
16494 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016495 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
16496 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
16497
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016498sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16499sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16500sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16501sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16502 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
16503 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
16504 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
16505 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
16506 when a first ACL was verified.
16507
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016508sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016509sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16510sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16511sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016512 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016513 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
16514
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016515sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016516sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
16517sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
16518sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016519 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
16520 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
16521 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
16522
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016523sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016524sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
16525sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
16526sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016527 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
16528 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
16529 See also src_conn_rate.
16530
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016531sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016532sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16533sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16534sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016535 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016536 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016537
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016538sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16539sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16540sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16541sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16542 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
16543 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
16544
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016545sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16546sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16547sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16548sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16549 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
16550 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
16551
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016552sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016553sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
16554sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
16555sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016556 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
16557 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
16558 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016559 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
16560 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16561 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016562
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016563sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16564sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16565sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16566sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16567 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
16568 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
16569 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
16570 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
16571 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16572 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
16573
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016574sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016575sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16576sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16577sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016578 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016579 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
16580 See also src_http_err_cnt.
16581
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016582sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016583sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
16584sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
16585sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016586 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
16587 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
16588 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
16589 src_http_err_rate.
16590
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016591sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016592sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16593sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16594sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016595 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016596 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
16597 src_http_req_cnt.
16598
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016599sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016600sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
16601sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
16602sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016603 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
16604 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
16605 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
16606 src_http_req_rate.
16607
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016608sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016609sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16610sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16611sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016612 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016613 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
16614 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
16615 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
16616 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016617
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016618 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016619 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
16620 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016621 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
16622
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016623sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16624sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16625sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16626sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16627 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
16628 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
16629 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
16630 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
16631 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
16632
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016633sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016634sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
16635sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
16636sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016637 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
16638 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
16639 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016640
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016641sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016642sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
16643sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
16644sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016645 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
16646 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
16647 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016648
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016649sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016650sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16651sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16652sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016653 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016654 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
16655 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
16656 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016657 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016658 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
16659
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016660sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016661sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
16662sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
16663sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016664 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
16665 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
16666 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
16667 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
16668 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016669 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016670
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016671sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016672sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
16673sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
16674sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020016675 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
16676 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
16677 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
16678
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016679sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016680sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
16681sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
16682sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010016683 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
16684 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016685 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010016686 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
16687 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016688 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
16689 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
16690 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010016691
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016692so_id : integer
16693 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
16694 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
16695 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016696
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010016697so_name : string
16698 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
16699 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
16700 strings instead of integers.
16701
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016702src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016703 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016704 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
16705 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
16706 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016707 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
16708 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
16709 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010016710 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
16711 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
16712 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
16713 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
16714 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
16715 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
16716 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016717
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016718 Example:
16719 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
16720 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
16721
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016722src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
16723 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
16724 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
16725 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016726 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016727
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016728src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
16729 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
16730 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016731 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016732 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016733
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016734src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16735 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16736 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16737 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
16738 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
16739 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
16740 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016741
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016742 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016743 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
16744 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
16745 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
16746 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016747 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016748 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
16749 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
16750
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016751src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16752 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16753 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16754 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
16755 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
16756 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
16757 was verified.
16758
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016759src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016760 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016761 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016762 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016763 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016764
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016765src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016766 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016767 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
16768 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016769 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016770
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016771src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
16772 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
16773 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16774 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016775 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016776
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016777src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016778 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016779 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016780 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016781 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016782
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016783src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16784 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
16785 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
16786 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
16787 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
16788
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016789src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16790 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
16791 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
16792 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
16793 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
16794
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016795src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016796 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016797 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016798 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
16799 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016800 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
16801 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16802 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016803
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016804src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16805 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
16806 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
16807 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
16808 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
16809 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
16810 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16811 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
16812
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016813src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016814 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016815 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016816 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016817 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016818 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016819
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016820src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
16821 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
16822 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16823 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
16824 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016825 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016826
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016827src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016828 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016829 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
16830 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016831 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016832
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016833src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
16834 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
16835 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
16836 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016837 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016838 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016839
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016840src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16841 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16842 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16843 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016844 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016845 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
16846 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016847
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016848 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016849 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016850 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016851 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016852
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016853src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16854 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16855 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16856 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
16857 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
16858 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
16859 connection when a first ACL was verified.
16860
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016861src_is_local : boolean
16862 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
16863 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
16864 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
16865 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016866 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016867 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
16868 once per connection.
16869
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016870src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016871 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
16872 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
16873 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
16874 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
16875 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016876
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016877src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016878 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
16879 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16880 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
16881 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
16882 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020016883
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016884src_port : integer
16885 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
16886 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
16887 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
16888 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010016889
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016890src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016891 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016892 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16893 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
16894 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016895 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016896
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016897src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
16898 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
16899 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16900 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
16901 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016902 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016903
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016904src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16905 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
16906 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
16907 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
16908 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
16909 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
16910 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
16911 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
16912 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020016913
16914 Example :
16915 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
16916 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
16917 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
16918 listen ssh
16919 bind :22
16920 mode tcp
16921 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016922 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016923 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020016924 server local 127.0.0.1:22
16925
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016926srv_id : integer
16927 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
16928 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016929 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020016930
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080016931srv_name : string
16932 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
16933 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016934 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080016935
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200169367.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016937----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020016938
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016939The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
16940closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
16941when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
16942usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016943future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020016944
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001694551d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
16946 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
16947 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
16948 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
16949 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
16950 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
16951
16952 Example :
16953 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
16954 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
16955 # the request.
16956 frontend http-in
16957 bind *:8081
16958 default_backend servers
16959 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
16960 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
16961
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016962ssl_bc : boolean
16963 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
16964 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016965 other a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
16966 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016967
16968ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
16969 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016970 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
16971 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016972
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016973ssl_bc_alpn : string
16974 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
16975 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020016976 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016977 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
16978 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
16979 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
16980 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
16981 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016982 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
16983 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016984
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016985ssl_bc_cipher : string
16986 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016987 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
16988 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016989
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016990ssl_bc_client_random : binary
16991 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
16992 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
16993 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016994 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016995
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010016996ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
16997 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
16998 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016999 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
17000 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010017001
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017002ssl_bc_npn : string
17003 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
17004 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020017005 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017006 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
17007 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
17008 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
17009 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017010 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
17011 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017012
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017013ssl_bc_protocol : string
17014 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017015 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
17016 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017017
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017018ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017019 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017020 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017021 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
17022 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017023
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017024ssl_bc_server_random : binary
17025 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
17026 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17027 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017028 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017029
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017030ssl_bc_session_id : binary
17031 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
17032 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017033 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
17034 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017035
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040017036ssl_bc_session_key : binary
17037 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
17038 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
17039 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017040 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040017041
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017042ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
17043 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017044 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
17045 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017046
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017047ssl_c_ca_err : integer
17048 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17049 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
17050 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
17051 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
17052 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020017053
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017054ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
17055 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17056 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
17057 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
17058 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017059
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010017060ssl_c_der : binary
17061 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
17062 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17063 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17064
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017065ssl_c_err : integer
17066 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17067 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
17068 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
17069 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
17070 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017071
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017072ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017073 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17074 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
17075 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17076 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17077 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17078 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17079 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17080 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017081 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17082 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17083 LDAP v3.
17084 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17085 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017086
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017087ssl_c_key_alg : string
17088 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
17089 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17090 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017091
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017092ssl_c_notafter : string
17093 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
17094 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17095 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020017096
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017097ssl_c_notbefore : string
17098 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
17099 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17100 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010017101
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017102ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017103 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17104 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
17105 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17106 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17107 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17108 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17109 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17110 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017111 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17112 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17113 LDAP v3.
17114 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17115 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010017116
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017117ssl_c_serial : binary
17118 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
17119 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17120 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017121
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017122ssl_c_sha1 : binary
17123 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
17124 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
17125 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020017126 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
17127 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
17128
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017129 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020017130 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017131
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017132ssl_c_sig_alg : string
17133 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
17134 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17135 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017136
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017137ssl_c_used : boolean
17138 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
17139 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020017140
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017141ssl_c_verify : integer
17142 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
17143 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
17144 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
17145 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020017146
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017147ssl_c_version : integer
17148 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
17149 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020017150
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010017151ssl_f_der : binary
17152 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
17153 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17154 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17155
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017156ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017157 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17158 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
17159 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17160 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017161 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017162 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17163 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17164 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017165 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17166 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17167 LDAP v3.
17168 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17169 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017170
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017171ssl_f_key_alg : string
17172 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
17173 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
17174 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020017175
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017176ssl_f_notafter : string
17177 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
17178 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17179 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017180
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017181ssl_f_notbefore : string
17182 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
17183 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17184 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017185
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017186ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017187 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17188 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
17189 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17190 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17191 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17192 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17193 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17194 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017195 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17196 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17197 LDAP v3.
17198 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17199 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020017200
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017201ssl_f_serial : binary
17202 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
17203 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17204 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017205
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020017206ssl_f_sha1 : binary
17207 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
17208 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
17209 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
17210
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017211ssl_f_sig_alg : string
17212 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
17213 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17214 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020017215
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017216ssl_f_version : integer
17217 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
17218 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
17219
17220ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017221 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
17222 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
17223 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
17224
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017225 Example :
17226 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
17227 listen http-https
17228 bind :80
17229 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
17230 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
17231
17232ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
17233 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
17234 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
17235
17236ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017237 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017238 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
17239 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
17240 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
17241 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
17242 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
17243 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
17244 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
17245 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
17246
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017247ssl_fc_cipher : string
17248 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
17249 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020017250
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017251ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
17252 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
17253 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010017254 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017255
17256ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
17257 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
17258 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010017259 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017260
17261ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
17262 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
17263 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
17264 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017265 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020017266 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017267
17268ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
17269 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
17270 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010017271 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017272
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017273ssl_fc_client_random : binary
17274 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
17275 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17276 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
17277
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020017278ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret : string
17279 Return the CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17280 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17281 transport layer.
17282 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17283 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17284 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17285 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17286
17287ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret : string
17288 Return the CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17289 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17290 transport layer.
17291 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17292 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17293 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17294 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17295
17296ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0 : string
17297 Return the CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
17298 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17299 transport layer.
17300 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17301 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17302 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17303 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17304
17305ssl_fc_exporter_secret : string
17306 Return the EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17307 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17308 transport layer.
17309 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17310 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17311 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17312 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17313
17314ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret : string
17315 Return the EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17316 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
17317 transport layer.
17318 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17319 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17320 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17321 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17322
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017323ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017324 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
17325 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010017326 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
17327 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
17328 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
17329 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017330
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020017331ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
17332 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
17333 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
17334 wait until the handshake happened.
17335
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017336ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
17337 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020017338 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
17339 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017340 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020017341 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020017342
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020017343ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020017344 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010017345 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
17346 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020017347
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017348ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017349 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017350 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
17351 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
17352 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
17353 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
17354 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
17355 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
17356 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020017357
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017358ssl_fc_protocol : string
17359 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
17360 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020017361
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017362ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040017363 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017364 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
17365 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040017366
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020017367ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret : string
17368 Return the SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17369 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17370 transport layer.
17371 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17372 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17373 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17374 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17375
17376ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0 : string
17377 Return the SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
17378 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
17379 transport layer.
17380 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17381 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17382 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17383 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17384
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017385ssl_fc_server_random : binary
17386 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
17387 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17388 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
17389
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017390ssl_fc_session_id : binary
17391 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
17392 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
17393 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
17394 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020017395
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040017396ssl_fc_session_key : binary
17397 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
17398 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
17399 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
17400 BoringSSL.
17401
17402
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017403ssl_fc_sni : string
17404 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
17405 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
17406 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
17407 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
17408 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
17409
17410 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
17411 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
17412 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017413 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020017414 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017415
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017416 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017417 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
17418 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020017419
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017420ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
17421 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
17422 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020017423
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017424ssl_s_der : binary
17425 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
17426 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17427 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17428
17429ssl_s_key_alg : string
17430 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
17431 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
17432 SSL/TLS transport layer.
17433
17434ssl_s_notafter : string
17435 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
17436 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17437 transport layer.
17438
17439ssl_s_notbefore : string
17440 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
17441 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17442 transport layer.
17443
17444ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
17445 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17446 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
17447 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17448 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17449 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17450 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020017451 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17452 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017453 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17454 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17455 LDAP v3.
17456 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17457 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
17458
17459ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
17460 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17461 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
17462 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17463 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17464 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17465 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020017466 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17467 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017468 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17469 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17470 LDAP v3.
17471 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17472 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
17473
17474ssl_s_serial : binary
17475 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
17476 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17477 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17478
17479ssl_s_sha1 : binary
17480 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
17481 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
17482 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
17483
17484ssl_s_sig_alg : string
17485 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
17486 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17487 layer.
17488
17489ssl_s_version : integer
17490 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
17491 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020017492
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200174937.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017494------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020017495
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017496Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
17497sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
17498only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
17499For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
17500be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
17501can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
17502sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
17503for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
17504content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017505
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017506payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017507 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017508 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
17509 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017510
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017511payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
17512 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017513 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017514 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017515
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020017516req.hdrs : string
17517 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
17518 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
17519 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
17520 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
17521
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020017522req.hdrs_bin : binary
17523 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
17524 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
17525 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
17526 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
17527 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
17528 names and values (length of 0 for both).
17529
17530 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
17531
17532 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
17533 str: <int:length><bytes>
17534
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017535req.len : integer
17536req_len : integer (deprecated)
17537 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
17538 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
17539 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
17540 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
17541 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
17542 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
17543 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
17544 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017545
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017546req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
17547 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020017548 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
17549 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
17550 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
17551 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017552
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017553 ACL alternatives :
17554 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017555
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017556req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
17557 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
17558 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
17559 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
17560 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017561
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017562 ACL alternatives :
17563 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017564
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017565 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017566
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017567req.proto_http : boolean
17568req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
17569 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
17570 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
17571 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
17572 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
17573 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
17574 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
17575 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017576
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017577 Example:
17578 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
17579 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
17580 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017581 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017582
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017583req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
17584rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17585 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
17586 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
17587 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
17588 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
17589 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
17590 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
17591 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017592
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017593 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
17594 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
17595 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
17596 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
17597 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
17598 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017599
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017600 ACL derivatives :
17601 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017602
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017603 Example :
17604 listen tse-farm
17605 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
17606 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
17607 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
17608 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
17609 # apply RDP cookie persistence
17610 persist rdp-cookie
17611 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
17612 # This is only useful makes sense if
17613 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
17614 stick-table type string size 204800
17615 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
17616 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
17617 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017618
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017619 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
17620 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017621
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017622req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
17623rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
17624 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
17625 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
17626 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
17627 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017628
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017629 ACL derivatives :
17630 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017631
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110017632req.ssl_alpn : string
17633 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
17634 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
17635 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
17636 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
17637 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
17638 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020017639 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110017640
17641 Examples :
17642 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
17643 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
17644 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020017645 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110017646 default_backend bk_default
17647
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020017648req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
17649 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
17650 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020017651 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
17652 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
17653 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
17654 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
17655 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020017656
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017657req.ssl_hello_type : integer
17658req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
17659 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
17660 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
17661 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
17662 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
17663 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
17664 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
17665 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017666
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017667req.ssl_sni : string
17668req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
17669 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
17670 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
17671 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
17672 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
17673 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020017674 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This will only work for actual
17675 implicit TLS based protocols like HTTPS (443), IMAPS (993), SMTPS (465),
17676 however it will not work for explicit TLS based protocols, like SMTP (25/587)
17677 or IMAP (143). SNI normally contains the name of the host the client tries to
17678 connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing or denying access
17679 to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This test was designed to
17680 be used with TCP request content inspection. If content switching is needed,
17681 it is recommended to first wait for a complete client hello (type 1), like in
17682 the example below. See also "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017683
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017684 ACL derivatives :
17685 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017686
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017687 Examples :
17688 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
17689 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
17690 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
17691 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
17692 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017693
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053017694req.ssl_st_ext : integer
17695 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
17696 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
17697 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
17698 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
17699 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
17700 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
17701 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
17702 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
17703 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
17704
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017705req.ssl_ver : integer
17706req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
17707 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
17708 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
17709 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
17710 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
17711 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
17712 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
17713 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017714 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017715 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017716
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017717 ACL derivatives :
17718 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017719
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020017720res.len : integer
17721 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
17722 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
17723 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
17724 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
17725 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
17726 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
17727 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017728 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020017729
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017730res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
17731 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020017732 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017733 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020017734 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017735 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017736
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017737res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
17738 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
17739 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
17740 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017741 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
17742 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017743
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017744 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017745
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020017746res.ssl_hello_type : integer
17747rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
17748 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
17749 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
17750 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
17751 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
17752 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
17753 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
17754 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
17755
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017756wait_end : boolean
17757 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
17758 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017759 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017760 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
17761 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017762 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017763 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
17764 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017765
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017766 Examples :
17767 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
17768 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
17769 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017770
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017771 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
17772 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
17773 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
17774 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
17775 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
17776 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
17777 tcp-request content reject
17778
17779
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200177807.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017781--------------------------------------
17782
17783It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
17784This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
17785data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
17786its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
17787HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
17788content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
17789to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
17790more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
17791response are indexed.
17792
17793base : string
17794 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
17795 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
17796 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
17797 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
17798 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
17799 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
17800 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
17801 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
17802
17803 ACL derivatives :
17804 base : exact string match
17805 base_beg : prefix match
17806 base_dir : subdir match
17807 base_dom : domain match
17808 base_end : suffix match
17809 base_len : length match
17810 base_reg : regex match
17811 base_sub : substring match
17812
17813base32 : integer
17814 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
17815 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
17816 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017817 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
17818 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
17819 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017820
17821base32+src : binary
17822 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
17823 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
17824 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
17825 per-URL counters.
17826
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010017827capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
17828 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
17829 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
17830 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
17831
17832capture.req.method : string
17833 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
17834 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
17835 because it's allocated.
17836
17837capture.req.uri : string
17838 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
17839 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
17840 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
17841 allocated.
17842
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020017843capture.req.ver : string
17844 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
17845 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
17846 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
17847
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010017848capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
17849 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
17850 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
17851 The first entry is an index of 0.
17852 See also: "capture response header"
17853
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020017854capture.res.ver : string
17855 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
17856 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
17857 persistent flag.
17858
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017859req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020017860 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
17861 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
17862 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017863
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020017864req.body_param([<name>) : string
17865 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
17866 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
17867 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
17868 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
17869 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
17870 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
17871 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
17872 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
17873 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
17874 given.
17875
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017876req.body_len : integer
17877 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
17878 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020017879 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
17880 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017881
17882req.body_size : integer
17883 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020017884 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
17885 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017886
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017887req.cook([<name>]) : string
17888cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17889 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
17890 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
17891 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
17892 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
17893 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
17894 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
17895 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
17896 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
17897
17898 ACL derivatives :
17899 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
17900 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
17901 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
17902 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
17903 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
17904 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
17905 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
17906 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017907
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017908req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17909cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17910 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
17911 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017912
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017913req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
17914cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17915 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
17916 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
17917 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
17918 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020017919
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017920cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17921 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
17922 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
17923 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
17924 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020017925 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017926 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
17927 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
17928 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
17929 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017930
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017931hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
17932 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
17933 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
17934 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
17935 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017936 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017937
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017938req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
17939 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
17940 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
17941 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
17942 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
17943 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
17944 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
17945 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
17946 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017947
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017948req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17949 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
17950 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
17951 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
17952 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017953
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017954req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
17955 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
17956 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
17957 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
17958 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
17959 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
17960 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
17961 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
17962 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000017963 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017964 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017965 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017966
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017967 ACL derivatives :
17968 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
17969 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
17970 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
17971 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
17972 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
17973 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
17974 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
17975 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
17976
17977req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17978hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
17979 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
17980 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
17981 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
17982 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
17983 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
17984 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
17985 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
17986 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
17987 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
17988
17989req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
17990hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
17991 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
17992 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
17993 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
17994 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
17995 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017996 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017997 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
17998 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
17999
18000req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
18001hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
18002 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
18003 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
18004 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
18005 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
18006 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
18007 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
18008 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
18009
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010018010
18011
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018012http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
18013 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
18014 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
18015 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
18016 basic auth is supported.
18017
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010018018http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
18019 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
18020 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
18021 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
18022 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018023 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
18024 basic auth is supported.
18025
18026 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010018027 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
18028 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
18029 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
18030 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018031
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018032http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010018033 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
18034 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
18035 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018036
18037http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010018038 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
18039 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
18040 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018041
18042http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010018043 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
18044 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
18045 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018046
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018047http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020018048 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
18049 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018050 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
18051 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020018052
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018053method : integer + string
18054 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
18055 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
18056 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
18057 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
18058 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
18059 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
18060 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018061
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018062 ACL derivatives :
18063 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018064
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018065 Example :
18066 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
18067 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
18068 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018069
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018070path : string
18071 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
18072 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
18073 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
18074 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
18075 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018076 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018077 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018078
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018079 ACL derivatives :
18080 path : exact string match
18081 path_beg : prefix match
18082 path_dir : subdir match
18083 path_dom : domain match
18084 path_end : suffix match
18085 path_len : length match
18086 path_reg : regex match
18087 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018088
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010018089query : string
18090 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
18091 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
18092 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
18093 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010018094 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010018095 which stops before the question mark.
18096
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010018097req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
18098 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
18099 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
18100 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
18101 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
18102
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018103req.ver : string
18104req_ver : string (deprecated)
18105 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
18106 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
18107 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018108
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018109 ACL derivatives :
18110 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020018111
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018112res.body : binary
18113 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
18114 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
18115 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context. It
18116 may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
18117
18118res.body_len : integer
18119 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
18120 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
18121 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context. It
18122 may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
18123
18124res.body_size : integer
18125 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
18126 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
18127 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
18128 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
18129 useful (and usable) in the health-check context. It may be used in tcp-check
18130 based expect rules.
18131
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018132res.comp : boolean
18133 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
18134 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
18135 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018136
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018137res.comp_algo : string
18138 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
18139 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
18140 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018141
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018142res.cook([<name>]) : string
18143scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18144 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
18145 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018146 specified, the first cookie value is returned. It may be used in tcp-check
18147 based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020018148
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018149 ACL derivatives :
18150 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020018151
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018152res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18153scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18154 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
18155 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018156 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses. It may
18157 be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018158
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018159res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
18160scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18161 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
18162 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018163 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. It may
18164 be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018165
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018166res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
18167 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
18168 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
18169 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
18170 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
18171 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
18172 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
18173 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
18174 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018175 Expires. It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018176
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018177res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18178 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
18179 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
18180 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
18181 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018182 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead. It may be used in
18183 tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018184
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018185res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
18186shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
18187 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
18188 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
18189 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
18190 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
18191 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
18192 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
18193 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018194 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead. It may be used in tcp-check based
18195 expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018196
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018197 ACL derivatives :
18198 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
18199 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
18200 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
18201 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
18202 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
18203 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
18204 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
18205 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
18206
18207res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18208shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18209 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
18210 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
18211 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
18212 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018213 instead. It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018214
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018215res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
18216shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
18217 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
18218 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
18219 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
18220 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
18221 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018222 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table. It
18223 may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018224
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010018225res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
18226 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
18227 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
18228 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018229 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered. It may be used
18230 in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010018231
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018232res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
18233shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
18234 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
18235 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
18236 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
18237 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
18238 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018239 useful to learn some data into a stick table. It may be used in tcp-check
18240 based expect rules.
18241
18242res.hdrs : string
18243 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
18244 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
18245 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
18246 headers analyzers and for advanced logging. It may also be used in tcp-check
18247 based expect rules.
18248
18249res.hdrs_bin : binary
18250 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
18251 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
18252 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
18253 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
18254 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
18255 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
18256 (length of 0 for both).
18257
18258 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
18259
18260 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
18261 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010018262
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018263res.ver : string
18264resp_ver : string (deprecated)
18265 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018266 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. It may be used in
18267 tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020018268
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018269 ACL derivatives :
18270 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010018271
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018272set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18273 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
18274 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020018275 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018276 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010018277
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018278 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
18279 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010018280
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018281status : integer
18282 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
18283 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018284 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx. It may be used in
18285 tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018286
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020018287unique-id : string
18288 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
18289 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
18290 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
18291 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
18292 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
18293 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
18294
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018295url : string
18296 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
18297 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
18298 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
18299 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
18300 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
18301 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
18302 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018303
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018304 ACL derivatives :
18305 url : exact string match
18306 url_beg : prefix match
18307 url_dir : subdir match
18308 url_dom : domain match
18309 url_end : suffix match
18310 url_len : length match
18311 url_reg : regex match
18312 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018313
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018314url_ip : ip
18315 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
18316 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
18317 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
18318 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
18319 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
18320 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
18321 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018322
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018323url_port : integer
18324 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
18325 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
18326 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
18327 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018328
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020018329urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
18330url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018331 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
18332 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020018333 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
18334 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
18335 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
18336 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018337 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
18338 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020018339 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
18340 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018341
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018342 ACL derivatives :
18343 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
18344 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
18345 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
18346 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
18347 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
18348 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
18349 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
18350 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018351
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018352
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018353 Example :
18354 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
18355 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
18356 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
18357 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018358
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018359urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018360 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
18361 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
18362 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020018363
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020018364url32 : integer
18365 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
18366 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
18367 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
18368 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
18369 is an unsigned integer.
18370
18371url32+src : binary
18372 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
18373 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
18374 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
18375
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020018376
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200183777.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018378---------------------------------------
18379
18380This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
18381used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
18382purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
18383There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
18384or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
18385any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
18386for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
18387
18388internal.htx.data : integer
18389 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
18390 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18391
18392internal.htx.free : integer
18393 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
18394 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18395
18396internal.htx.free_data : integer
18397 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
18398 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18399
18400internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
18401 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains an
18402 end-of-message block (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is
18403 chosen depending on the sample direction.
18404
18405internal.htx.nbblks : integer
18406 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
18407 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18408
18409internal.htx.size : integer
18410 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
18411 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18412
18413internal.htx.used : integer
18414 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
18415 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18416 direction.
18417
18418internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
18419 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
18420 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
18421 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
18422 of the special value :
18423 * head : The oldest inserted block
18424 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018425 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018426
18427internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
18428 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
18429 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
18430 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
18431 integer or one of the special value :
18432 * head : The oldest inserted block
18433 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018434 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018435
18436internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
18437 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
18438 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
18439 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18440 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18441
18442 * head : The oldest inserted block
18443 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018444 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018445
18446internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
18447 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
18448 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
18449 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18450 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18451
18452 * head : The oldest inserted block
18453 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018454 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018455
18456internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
18457 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
18458 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
18459 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18460 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18461
18462 * head : The oldest inserted block
18463 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018464 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018465
18466internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
18467 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
18468 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
18469 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18470 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18471
18472 * head : The oldest inserted block
18473 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018474 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018475
18476internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
18477 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
18478 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
18479 it returns false.
18480
18481
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200184827.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018483---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010018484
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018485Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
18486every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020018487order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010018488
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018489ACL name Equivalent to Usage
18490---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018491FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020018492HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018493HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
18494HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018495HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
18496HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
18497HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
18498HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
18499LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018500METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020018501METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018502METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
18503METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
18504METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
18505METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020018506METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018507METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020018508RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018509REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018510TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018511WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
18512---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010018513
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010018514
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200185158. Logging
18516----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010018517
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018518One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
18519provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
18520very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
18521provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
18522state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018523to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018524headers.
18525
18526In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
18527about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
18528send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
18529
18530 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
18531 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
18532 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
18533 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
18534 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018535 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060018536 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018537
18538The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
18539allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
18540as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
18541while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
18542real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
18543delay.
18544
18545
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200185468.1. Log levels
18547---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018548
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090018549TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018550source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090018551HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
18552in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
18553track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
18554syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
18555about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018556
18557
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200185588.2. Log formats
18559----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018560
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018561HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090018562and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
18563slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
18564options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018565
18566 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
18567 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
18568 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
18569 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
18570 extents.
18571
18572 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
18573 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
18574 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
18575 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
18576 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
18577
18578 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
18579 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
18580 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
18581 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
18582 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
18583
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020018584 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
18585 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
18586 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
18587 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
18588
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018589 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
18590
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018591Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
18592specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
18593field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
18594servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
18595always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
18596identifier.
18597
18598Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
18599 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
18600 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
18601 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
18602 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
18603
18604
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200186058.2.1. Default log format
18606-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018607
18608This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
18609as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
18610format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
18611
18612 Example :
18613 listen www
18614 mode http
18615 log global
18616 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
18617
18618 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
18619 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
18620 (www/HTTP)
18621
18622 Field Format Extract from the example above
18623 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
18624 2 'Connect from' Connect from
18625 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
18626 4 'to' to
18627 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
18628 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
18629
18630Detailed fields description :
18631 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
18632 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
18633 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
18634 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
18635 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
18636 and processed the connection.
18637 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
18638
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018639In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
18640"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
18641connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
18642
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018643It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
18644will eventually disappear.
18645
18646
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200186478.2.2. TCP log format
18648---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018649
18650The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
18651is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
18652information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
18653counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
18654emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
18655environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
18656the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
18657sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020018658specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
18659not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
18660fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
18661marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018662
18663 Example :
18664 frontend fnt
18665 mode tcp
18666 option tcplog
18667 log global
18668 default_backend bck
18669
18670 backend bck
18671 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
18672
18673 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
18674 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
18675 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
18676
18677 Field Format Extract from the example above
18678 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
18679 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
18680 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
18681 4 frontend_name fnt
18682 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
18683 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
18684 7 bytes_read* 212
18685 8 termination_state --
18686 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
18687 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
18688
18689Detailed fields description :
18690 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018691 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
18692 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
18693 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018694 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018695 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018696 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018697
18698 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018699 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
18700 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
18701 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018702
18703 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
18704 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
18705 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018706 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
18707 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
18708 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
18709 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018710
18711 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
18712 and processed the connection.
18713
18714 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
18715 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
18716 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
18717 applications.
18718
18719 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
18720 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
18721 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
18722 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
18723 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
18724
18725 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
18726 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
18727 See "Timers" below for more details.
18728
18729 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
18730 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
18731 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
18732 "Timers" below for more details.
18733
18734 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018735 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018736 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
18737 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
18738 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
18739 details.
18740
18741 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
18742 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
18743 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
18744 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
18745 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
18746
18747 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
18748 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
18749 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
18750 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
18751 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
18752 for more details.
18753
18754 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018755 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018756 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
18757 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
18758 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018759 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018760
18761 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
18762 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
18763 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
18764 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
18765 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
18766 caused by a denial of service attack.
18767
18768 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
18769 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
18770 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
18771 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
18772 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
18773 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
18774 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
18775 denial of service attack.
18776
18777 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
18778 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
18779 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
18780 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
18781 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
18782 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
18783 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
18784 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
18785 be processed than on other servers.
18786
18787 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
18788 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
18789 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
18790 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
18791 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
18792 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
18793 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
18794 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
18795 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
18796 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
18797 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
18798 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
18799 should not be attributed to the logged server.
18800
18801 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
18802 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
18803 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
18804 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
18805 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
18806 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018807 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018808 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
18809
18810 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
18811 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
18812 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
18813 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
18814 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
18815 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018816 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018817 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
18818 occurs.
18819
18820
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200188218.2.3. HTTP log format
18822----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018823
18824The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
18825is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
18826the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
18827are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
18828emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
18829generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
18830"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
18831which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020018832frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
18833is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018834
18835Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
18836slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
18837with a star ('*') after the field name below.
18838
18839 Example :
18840 frontend http-in
18841 mode http
18842 option httplog
18843 log global
18844 default_backend bck
18845
18846 backend static
18847 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
18848
18849 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
18850 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
18851 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018852 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018853
18854 Field Format Extract from the example above
18855 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
18856 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018857 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018858 4 frontend_name http-in
18859 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018860 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018861 7 status_code 200
18862 8 bytes_read* 2750
18863 9 captured_request_cookie -
18864 10 captured_response_cookie -
18865 11 termination_state ----
18866 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
18867 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
18868 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
18869 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
18870 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018871
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018872Detailed fields description :
18873 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018874 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
18875 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
18876 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018877 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018878 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018879 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018880
18881 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018882 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
18883 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
18884 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018885
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018886 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
18887 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018888
18889 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
18890 and processed the connection.
18891
18892 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
18893 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
18894 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
18895
18896 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
18897 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
18898 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
18899 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
18900 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
18901 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
18902
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018903 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
18904 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
18905 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018906 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018907 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
18908 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018909 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
18910 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018911
18912 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
18913 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018914 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018915
18916 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
18917 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018918 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
18919 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018920
18921 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
18922 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
18923 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
18924 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
18925 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018926 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
18927 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018928
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018929 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
18930 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
18931 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
18932 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
18933 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
18934 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
18935 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018936 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018937
18938 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
18939 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
18940 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
18941
18942 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
18943 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018944 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018945 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
18946 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
18947 overflowing.
18948
18949 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
18950 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
18951 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
18952 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
18953 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
18954 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
18955 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
18956 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
18957
18958 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
18959 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
18960 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
18961 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
18962 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
18963 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
18964 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
18965 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
18966
18967 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
18968 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
18969 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
18970 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
18971 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
18972 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
18973 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
18974
18975 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018976 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018977 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
18978 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
18979 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018980 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018981 system.
18982
18983 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
18984 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
18985 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
18986 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
18987 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
18988 caused by a denial of service attack.
18989
18990 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
18991 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
18992 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
18993 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
18994 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
18995 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
18996 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
18997 denial of service attack.
18998
18999 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
19000 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
19001 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
19002 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
19003 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
19004 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
19005 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
19006 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
19007 processed than on other servers.
19008
19009 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
19010 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
19011 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
19012 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
19013 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
19014 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
19015 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
19016 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
19017 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
19018 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
19019 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
19020 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
19021 should not be attributed to the logged server.
19022
19023 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19024 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
19025 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
19026 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
19027 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
19028 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019029 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019030 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
19031
19032 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19033 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
19034 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
19035 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
19036 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
19037 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019038 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019039 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
19040 occurs.
19041
19042 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
19043 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
19044 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
19045 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
19046 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
19047 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
19048 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
19049 cookies" below for more details.
19050
19051 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
19052 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
19053 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
19054 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
19055 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
19056 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
19057 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
19058 and cookies" below for more details.
19059
19060 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
19061 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
19062 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
19063 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
19064 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
19065 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
19066 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
19067 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
19068
19069
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200190708.2.4. Custom log format
19071------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019072
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019073The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019074mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019075
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019076HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019077Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
19078separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
19079prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
19080
19081Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
19082variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019083("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019084
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010019085If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020019086as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010019087less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
19088the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
19089
Dragan Dosen1e3b16f2020-06-23 18:16:44 +020019090Note: spaces must be escaped. In configuration directives "log-format",
19091"log-format-sd" and "unique-id-format", spaces are considered as
19092delimiters and are merged. In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be
19093preceded by another '%' resulting in '%%'.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019094
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019095Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
19096'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
19097https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
19098such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
19099
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019100Flags are :
19101 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019102 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019103 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
19104 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019105
19106 Example:
19107
19108 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
19109 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
19110
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019111 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
19112
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019113At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
19114
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019115 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
19116 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019117
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019118the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019119
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019120 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
19121 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
19122 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019123
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019124and the default TCP format is defined this way :
19125
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019126 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
19127 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019128
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019129Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
19130
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019131 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019132 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019133 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
19134 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
19135 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019136 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
19137 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
19138 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019139 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000019140 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
19141 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000019142 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000019143 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
19144 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010019145 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020019146 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019147 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019148 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019149 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020019150 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080019151 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019152 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
19153 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
19154 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
19155 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
19156 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019157 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019158 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000019159 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019160 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019161 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019162 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
19163 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019164 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
19165 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
19166 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019167 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019168 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
19169 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019170 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019171 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
19172 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
19173 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020019174 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020019175 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020019176 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
19177 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
19178 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
19179 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020019180 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019181 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019182 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019183 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010019184 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019185 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019186 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
19187 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
19188 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019189 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019190 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
19191 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019192 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019193 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
19194 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020019195 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019196 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019197 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019198 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019199
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019200 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019201
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010019202
192038.2.5. Error log format
19204-----------------------
19205
19206When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
19207protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
19208By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
19209"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019210will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010019211logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
19212
19213The format looks like this :
19214
19215 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
19216 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
19217 Connection error during SSL handshake
19218
19219 Field Format Extract from the example above
19220 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
19221 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
19222 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
19223 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
19224 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
19225
19226These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
19227failures.
19228
19229
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200192308.3. Advanced logging options
19231-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019232
19233Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
19234just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
19235options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
19236for more information about their usage.
19237
19238
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200192398.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
19240------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019241
19242It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
19243haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
19244commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
19245monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
19246ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
19247
19248 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
19249 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
19250 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
19251 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
19252
19253 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
19254 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
19255 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019256 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019257 such as other load-balancers.
19258
19259 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
19260 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
19261 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
19262
19263
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200192648.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
19265----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019266
19267The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
19268what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
19269or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019270"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019271just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
19272log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
19273after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
19274is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
19275with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
19276with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
19277
19278
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200192798.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
19280------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019281
19282Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
19283for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
19284"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
19285retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
19286raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
19287a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
19288file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
19289you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
19290"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
19291
19292
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200192938.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
19294--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019295
19296Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
19297multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
19298them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
19299"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
19300logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
19301error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
19302and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
19303too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
19304useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
19305alternative.
19306
19307
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200193088.4. Timing events
19309------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019310
19311Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
19312reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
19313the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
19314frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019315mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
19316addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
19317
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010019318Timings events in HTTP mode:
19319
19320 first request 2nd request
19321 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
19322 t tr t tr ...
19323 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
19324 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
19325 :<---- Tq ---->: :
19326 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000019327 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010019328 :<--------- Ta --------->:
19329
19330Timings events in TCP mode:
19331
19332 TCP session
19333 |<----------------->|
19334 t t
19335 ---|----|----|----|----|---
19336 | Th Tw Tc Td |
19337 |<------ Tt ------->|
19338
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019339 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019340 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019341 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
19342 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
19343 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019344 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019345 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
19346 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
19347 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
19348 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019349
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019350 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
19351 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
19352 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019353 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
19354 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
19355 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
19356 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
19357 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
19358 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019359
19360 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
19361 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
19362 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
19363 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
19364 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
19365 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
19366 request typed by hand during a test.
19367
19368 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
19369 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019370 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019371 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
19372 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
19373 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
19374 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019375
19376 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
19377 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
19378 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
19379 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
19380 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
19381
19382 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
19383 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
19384 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
19385 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
19386 connection never established.
19387
19388 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
19389 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
19390 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
19391 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
19392 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
19393 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
19394 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
19395 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
19396 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
19397 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
19398 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
19399
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019400 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
19401 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
19402 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
19403 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
19404 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
19405 by subtracting other timers when valid :
19406
19407 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
19408
19409 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
19410 "Ta" can never be negative.
19411
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019412 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
19413 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019414 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
19415 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019416 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019417
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019418 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019419
19420 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019421 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
19422 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019423
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000019424 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
19425 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
19426 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
19427 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
19428 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
19429 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
19430 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
19431 prefixed with a '+' sign.
19432
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019433These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
19434protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
19435that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019436due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
19437"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
19438that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019439
19440Most common cases :
19441
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019442 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
19443 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
19444 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
19445 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
19446 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
19447 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
19448 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
19449 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
19450 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
19451 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
19452 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020019453 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019454
19455 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
19456 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
19457 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
19458 of ms on remote networks.
19459
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019460 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
19461 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
19462 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019463
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019464 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
19465 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
19466 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
19467 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
19468 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
19469 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
19470 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
19471 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
19472 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019473
19474Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
19475
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019476 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019477 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019478 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019479
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019480 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019481 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
19482 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
19483
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019484 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019485 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
19486 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
19487 flags.
19488
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019489 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
19490 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019491 Check the session termination flags, then check the
19492 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
19493 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
19494 the client connection was maintained open.
19495
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019496 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019497 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019498 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019499 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
19500
19501
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200195028.5. Session state at disconnection
19503-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019504
19505TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
19506"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
195072-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
19508each of which has a special meaning :
19509
19510 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
19511 session to terminate :
19512
19513 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
19514
19515 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
19516 server explicitly refused it.
19517
19518 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
19519 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
19520 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
19521 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019522 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020019523
19524 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
19525 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019526
19527 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
19528 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
19529 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
19530 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
19531 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
19532
19533 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
19534 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
19535 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
19536 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
19537 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
19538
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090019539 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
19540 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
19541
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070019542 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
19543 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
19544 backup connections when going up.
19545
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020019546 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
19547
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019548 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
19549 send or receive data.
19550
19551 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
19552 send or receive data.
19553
19554 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
19555 with nothing left in the buffers.
19556
19557 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
19558
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010019559 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019560 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
19561
19562 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
19563 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
19564 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
19565 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
19566 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
19567
19568 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
19569 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
19570
19571 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
19572 server (HTTP only).
19573
19574 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
19575
19576 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
19577 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
19578 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
19579
19580 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
19581 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
19582 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
19583
19584 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
19585
19586 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
19587 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
19588
19589 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
19590 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
19591 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
19592
19593 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
19594 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020019595 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
19596 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019597
19598 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
19599 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
19600 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
19601 another server.
19602
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019603 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019604 server.
19605
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019606 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
19607 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
19608 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
19609 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
19610
19611 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
19612 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
19613 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
19614 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
19615
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020019616 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
19617 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
19618 "use-server" rule).
19619
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019620 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
19621
19622 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
19623 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
19624
19625 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
19626
19627 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
19628 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
19629 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
19630
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019631 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
19632 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019633 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019634 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
19635 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
19636
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019637 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
19638
19639 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
19640 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
19641
19642 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
19643
19644 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
19645
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019646The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
19647was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019648helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
19649starvation, attacks, etc...
19650
19651The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
19652alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
19653easier finding and understanding.
19654
19655 Flags Reason
19656
19657 -- Normal termination.
19658
19659 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
19660 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
19661 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
19662 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
19663
19664 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
19665 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
19666 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
19667 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
19668 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
19669 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019670
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019671 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
19672 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020019673 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019674
19675 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
19676 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
19677 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
19678
19679 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
19680 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
19681 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
19682 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
19683 the server takes too long to respond.
19684
19685 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
19686 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
19687 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
19688 long a time to respond.
19689
19690 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
19691 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
19692 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
19693 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020019694 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
19695 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019696
19697 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
19698 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
19699 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
19700 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
19701 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020019702 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020019703 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
19704 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
19705 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
19706 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
19707 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
19708 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
19709 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
19710 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019711 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020019712 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
19713 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
19714 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019715
19716 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
19717 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019718 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
19719 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
19720 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
19721 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019722
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020019723 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
19724 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
19725
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010019726 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019727 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
19728 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019729 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019730 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
19731 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
19732
19733 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
19734 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
19735 503 or 504 here.
19736
19737 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
19738 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
19739 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
19740 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
19741 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
19742
19743 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
19744 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019745 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019746 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
19747 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
19748
19749 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
19750 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
19751 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
19752 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
19753 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
19754 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
19755 between haproxy and the server.
19756
19757 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
19758 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
19759 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
19760 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
19761 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
19762 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
19763 solution is to fix the application.
19764
19765 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
19766 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
19767 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
19768 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
19769 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
19770 external attacks.
19771
19772 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
19773 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020019774 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019775 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
19776 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
19777
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010019778 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
19779 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
19780 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019781 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020019782 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010019783
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019784 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
19785 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
19786 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
19787 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010019788 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
19789 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
19790 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
19791 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
19792 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019793
19794 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
19795 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
19796 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
19797 returned an HTTP 403 error.
19798
19799 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
19800 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
19801 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
19802 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
19803
19804 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
19805 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
19806 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
19807 only be solved by proper system tuning.
19808
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019809The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
19810persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
19811important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
19812re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
19813
19814 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
19815
19816 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
19817 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
19818 set on a GET request.
19819
19820 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
19821 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019822 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019823 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
19824
19825 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
19826 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
19827 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
19828
19829 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
19830 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
19831 already got a cookie.
19832
19833 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
19834 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
19835 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
19836 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
19837 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
19838
19839 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
19840 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
19841 new cookie was inserted in the response.
19842
19843 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
19844 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
19845 new cookie was inserted in the response.
19846
19847 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
19848 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
19849
19850 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
19851 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
19852 then advertised in the response.
19853
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019854
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200198558.6. Non-printable characters
19856-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019857
19858In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
19859consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
19860converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
19861prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
19862being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
19863escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
19864is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
19865'}' when logging headers.
19866
19867Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
19868issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
19869containing spaces is "User-Agent".
19870
19871Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
19872the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
19873performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
19874
19875
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200198768.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
19877---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019878
19879Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
19880achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019881section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019882cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
19883the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
19884the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019885locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019886not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
19887user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
19888a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
19889wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
19890
19891 Examples :
19892 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
19893 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
19894
19895 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
19896 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
19897
19898
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200198998.8. Capturing HTTP headers
19900---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019901
19902Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
19903proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
19904the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
19905server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
19906
19907Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
19908response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019909section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019910
19911It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010019912time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
19913appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019914are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
19915and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
19916follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
19917request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
19918in the logs.
19919
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020019920As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
19921frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
19922an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
19923
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019924 Example :
19925 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
19926 listen proxy-out
19927 mode http
19928 option httplog
19929 option logasap
19930 log global
19931 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
19932
19933 # log the name of the virtual server
19934 capture request header Host len 20
19935
19936 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
19937 capture request header Content-Length len 10
19938
19939 # log the beginning of the referrer
19940 capture request header Referer len 20
19941
19942 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
19943 capture response header Server len 20
19944
19945 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
19946 capture response header Content-Length len 10
19947
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019948 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019949 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
19950
19951 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
19952 capture response header Via len 20
19953
19954 # log the URL location during a redirection
19955 capture response header Location len 20
19956
19957 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
19958 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
19959 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
19960 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
19961 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
19962
19963 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
19964 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
19965 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
19966 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019967 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019968
19969 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
19970 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
19971 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
19972 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
19973 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019974 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019975
19976
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200199778.9. Examples of logs
19978---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019979
19980These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
19981them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
19982reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
19983
19984 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
19985 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
19986 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
19987
19988 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
19989 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
19990
19991 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
19992 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
19993 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
19994
19995 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
19996 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
19997
19998 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
19999 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
20000 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
20001
20002 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020003 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020004 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
20005 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
20006
20007 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
20008 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
20009 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
20010
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020020011 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
20012 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
20013 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
20014 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
20015 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided to
20016 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020017
20018 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020019 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020020
20021 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
20022 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
20023 Nothing was sent to any server.
20024
20025 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
20026 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
20027
20028 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
20029 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020030 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020031 send a 408 return code to the client.
20032
20033 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
20034 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
20035
20036 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
20037 5 seconds ("c----").
20038
20039 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
20040 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020041 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020042
20043 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020044 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020045 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
20046 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
20047 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
20048 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
20049 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010020050
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020020051
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200200529. Supported filters
20053--------------------
20054
20055Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
20056accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
20057unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
20058
20059See also : "filter"
20060
200619.1. Trace
20062----------
20063
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010020064filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020065
20066 Arguments:
20067 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
20068 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
20069
20070 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
20071 the client and the server. By default, this filter
20072 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
20073 only parses a random amount of the available data.
20074
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020075 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020076 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
20077 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
20078 amount of the parsed data.
20079
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020080 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010020081
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020082This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
20083callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
20084information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
20085filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
20086
20087Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
20088tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
20089a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
20090
20091
200929.2. HTTP compression
20093---------------------
20094
20095filter compression
20096
20097The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
20098keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020099when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
20100fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
20101done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
20102explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
20103filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
20104listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
20105order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020106
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020107See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
20108 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020109
20110
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200201119.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
20112--------------------------------------------
20113
20114filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
20115
20116 Arguments :
20117
20118 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
20119 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
20120 parsed.
20121
20122 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
20123 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
20124 part must be placed in its own scope.
20125
20126The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
20127external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020128streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020020129exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
20130also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
20131
20132SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
20133the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
20134
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010020135For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020020136"doc/SPOE.txt".
20137
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100201389.4. Cache
20139----------
20140
20141filter cache <name>
20142
20143 Arguments :
20144
20145 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
20146
20147The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
20148"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020149cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020150other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
20151case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
20152is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
20153filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010020154listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
20155order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010020156
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020157See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
20158 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
20159
20160
201619.5. Fcgi-app
20162-------------
20163
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040020164filter fcgi-app <name>
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020165
20166 Arguments :
20167
20168 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
20169
20170The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
20171request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
20172reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
20173used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
20174implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
20175used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
20176fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
20177used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
20178order.
20179
20180See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
20181 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
20182
20183
2018410. FastCGI applications
20185-------------------------
20186
20187HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
20188feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
20189the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
20190FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
20191servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
20192FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
20193backend.
20194
20195HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
20196application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
20197connection.
20198
2019910.1. Setup
20200-----------
20201
2020210.1.1. Fcgi-app section
20203--------------------------
20204
20205fcgi-app <name>
20206 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
20207 document root must be defined.
20208
20209acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
20210 Declare or complete an access list.
20211
20212 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
20213 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
20214 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
20215 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
20216 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
20217
20218docroot <path>
20219 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
20220 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
20221 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
20222
20223index <script-name>
20224 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
20225 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
20226 is an optional setting.
20227
20228 Example :
20229 index index.php
20230
20231log-stderr global
20232log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
20233 [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
20234 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
20235
20236 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
20237 default STDERR messages are ignored.
20238
20239pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
20240 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
20241 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
20242 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
20243
20244 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
20245 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
20246 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
20247 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
20248
20249 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
20250 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
20251
20252path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010020253 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010020254 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
20255 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
20256 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
20257 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
20258 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
20259 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
20260 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010020261
20262 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020263 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010020264 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
20265 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
20266 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
20267 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020268
20269 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010020270 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
20271 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020272
20273option get-values
20274no option get-values
20275 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
20276
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040020277 HAProxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020278 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
20279
20280 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
20281 application will accept.
20282
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020020283 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
20284 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020285
20286 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050020287 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020288 option is disabled.
20289
20290 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
20291 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
20292 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
20293 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
20294 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
20295 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
20296
20297option keep-conn
20298no option keep-conn
20299 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
20300 sending a response.
20301
20302 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
20303 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
20304
20305option max-reqs <reqs>
20306 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
20307 accept.
20308
20309 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
20310 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
20311 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
20312 to 1.
20313
20314option mpxs-conns
20315no option mpxs-conns
20316 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
20317
20318 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
20319 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
20320
20321set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
20322 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
20323 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
20324 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
20325 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
20326
20327 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
20328 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
20329 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
20330
20331 Example :
20332 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
20333 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
20334
20335 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
20336
20337
2033810.1.2. Proxy section
20339---------------------
20340
20341use-fcgi-app <name>
20342 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
20343
20344 Arguments :
20345 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
20346
20347 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
20348 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
20349 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
20350 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
20351 application may be defined at a time per backend.
20352
20353 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
20354 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
20355 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
20356 application are evaluated.
20357
20358
2035910.1.3. Example
20360---------------
20361
20362 frontend front-http
20363 mode http
20364 bind *:80
20365 bind *:
20366
20367 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
20368 default_backend back-static
20369
20370 backend back-static
20371 mode http
20372 server www A.B.C.D:80
20373
20374 backend back-dynamic
20375 mode http
20376 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
20377 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
20378
20379 fcgi-app php-fpm
20380 log-stderr global
20381 option keep-conn
20382
20383 docroot /var/www/my-app
20384 index index.php
20385 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
20386
20387
2038810.2. Default parameters
20389------------------------
20390
20391A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
20392the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020393script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020394applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
20395
20396 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20397 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
20398 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
20399 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
20400 | | |
20401 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20402 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
20403 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
20404 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
20405 | | application. |
20406 | | |
20407 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20408 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
20409 | | the request. It may not be set. |
20410 | | |
20411 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20412 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
20413 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
20414 | | the application's configuration. |
20415 | | |
20416 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20417 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
20418 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
20419 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
20420 | | |
20421 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20422 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
20423 | | following the part that identifies the script |
20424 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
20425 | | be defined. |
20426 | | |
20427 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20428 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
20429 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
20430 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
20431 | | is not set too. |
20432 | | |
20433 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20434 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
20435 | | set. |
20436 | | |
20437 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20438 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
20439 | | the request. |
20440 | | |
20441 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20442 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
20443 | | client as part of user authentication. |
20444 | | |
20445 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20446 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
20447 | | script to process the request. |
20448 | | |
20449 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20450 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
20451 | | |
20452 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20453 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
20454 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
20455 | | |
20456 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20457 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
20458 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
20459 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
20460 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
20461 | | |
20462 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20463 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
20464 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
20465 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
20466 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
20467 | | side. |
20468 | | |
20469 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20470 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
20471 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
20472 | | connected to. |
20473 | | |
20474 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20475 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
20476 | | |
20477 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20478 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
20479 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
20480 | | |
20481 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20482
20483
2048410.3. Limitations
20485------------------
20486
20487The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
20488way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
20489during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
20490establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
20491application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
20492or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
20493message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
20494these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
20495and HTTP servers under the same backend.
20496
20497Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
20498request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
20499requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
20500
20501About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
20502into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
20503fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
20504"http-request" ones.
20505
20506Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
20507FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
20508processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
20509must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
20510here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010020511
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010020512/*
20513 * Local variables:
20514 * fill-column: 79
20515 * End:
20516 */